]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
(Version, mh-version): Update for release 8.0.
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
159
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
166
167 \f
168
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
170
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
172
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
175
176 static int any_help_event_p;
177
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
180
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
182
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
184
185 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
186 use. */
187
188 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
189
190 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
191 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
192 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
193 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
194
195 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
196
197 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
198 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
199 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
200 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
201
202 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
203
204 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
205
206 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
207
208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
209 /* The application context for Xt use. */
210 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
211 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
213
214 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
215
216 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
217
218 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
219 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
220
221 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
222
223 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
224 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
225 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
226
227 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
228
229 /* Mouse movement.
230
231 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
232 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
233 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
234 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
235
236 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
237
238 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
239 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
240 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
241 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
242 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
243 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
244 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
245 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
246 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
247 is off. */
248
249 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
250
251 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
252 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
253 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
254
255 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
256
257 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
258 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
259 an ordinary motion.
260
261 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
262 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
263 event. */
264
265 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
266
267 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
268 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
269 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
270 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
271 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
272 it's somewhat accurate. */
273
274 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
275
276 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
277 events. */
278
279 #ifdef __STDC__
280 static int volatile input_signal_count;
281 #else
282 static int input_signal_count;
283 #endif
284
285 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
286
287 static int x_noop_count;
288
289 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
290
291 extern char **initial_argv;
292 extern int initial_argc;
293
294 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
295
296 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
297
298 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
299
300 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
301
302 extern int errno;
303
304 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
305
306 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
307
308 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
309
310 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
311 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
312 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
313
314 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
315 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
316
317 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
318 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
319
320 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
321 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
322 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
323 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
324 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
325
326 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
327 void x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
328 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((void));
329 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
330 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
331 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
332 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
333 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
334 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
335 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
336 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
337 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
338 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
339 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
340 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
341 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
343 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
344 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
345 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
346 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
348 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
349 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
350 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
351 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
352 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
353 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
354 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
355 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
356 enum text_cursor_kinds));
357
358 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
359 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
360 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
362 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
363 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
364 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
365 enum scroll_bar_part *,
366 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
367 unsigned long *));
368 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
369 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
371 int *, struct input_event *));
372
373
374 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
375
376 static void
377 x_flush (f)
378 struct frame *f;
379 {
380 BLOCK_INPUT;
381 if (f == NULL)
382 {
383 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
384 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
385 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
386 }
387 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
390 }
391
392
393 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
394 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
395 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
396 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
397 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
398 performance. */
399
400 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
401
402 \f
403 /***********************************************************************
404 Debugging
405 ***********************************************************************/
406
407 #if 0
408
409 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
410 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
411
412 struct record
413 {
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 };
417
418 struct record event_record[100];
419
420 int event_record_index;
421
422 record_event (locus, type)
423 char *locus;
424 int type;
425 {
426 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
427 event_record_index = 0;
428
429 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
430 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
431 event_record_index++;
432 }
433
434 #endif /* 0 */
435
436
437 \f
438 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
439
440 struct x_display_info *
441 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
442 Display *dpy;
443 {
444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
445
446 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
447 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
448 return dpyinfo;
449
450 return 0;
451 }
452
453
454 \f
455 /***********************************************************************
456 Starting and ending an update
457 ***********************************************************************/
458
459 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
460 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
461 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
462 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
463 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
464
465 static void
466 x_update_begin (f)
467 struct frame *f;
468 {
469 /* Nothing to do. */
470 }
471
472
473 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
474 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
475 position of W. */
476
477 static void
478 x_update_window_begin (w)
479 struct window *w;
480 {
481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
482 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
483
484 updated_window = w;
485 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
486
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
488
489 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
490 {
491 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
492 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
493
494 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
495 highlighting. */
496 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
497 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
498
499 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
500 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
501 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
502 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
503 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
504 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
505
506 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
507 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
508 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
509 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
510 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
511 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
512 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
513 {
514 int i;
515
516 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
517 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
518 break;
519
520 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
521 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
522 }
523 #endif /* 0 */
524 }
525
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
527 }
528
529
530 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
531
532 static void
533 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
534 struct window *w;
535 int x, y0, y1;
536 {
537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
538 struct face *face;
539
540 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
541 if (face)
542 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
543 face->foreground);
544
545 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
546 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
547 }
548
549 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
550
551 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
552 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
553
554 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
555 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
556 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
557
558 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
559 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
560 here. */
561
562 static void
563 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
564 struct window *w;
565 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
566 {
567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
568
569 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
570 {
571 BLOCK_INPUT;
572
573 if (cursor_on_p)
574 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
575 output_cursor.vpos,
576 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
577
578 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
579 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
580
581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
582 }
583
584 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
585 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
586 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
587 {
588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
591 }
592
593 updated_window = NULL;
594 }
595
596
597 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
598 update_end. */
599
600 static void
601 x_update_end (f)
602 struct frame *f;
603 {
604 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
605 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
606
607 #ifndef XFlush
608 BLOCK_INPUT;
609 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
611 #endif
612 }
613
614
615 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
616 complete update has been performed. The global variable
617 updated_window is not available here. */
618
619 static void
620 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
621 struct frame *f;
622 {
623 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
624 {
625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
626
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
628 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
629 {
630 BLOCK_INPUT;
631 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
632 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
636 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
637 }
638 }
639 }
640
641
642 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
643 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
644 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
645 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
646 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
647 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
648
649 static void
650 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
651 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
652 {
653 struct window *w = updated_window;
654 struct frame *f;
655 int width, height;
656
657 xassert (w);
658
659 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
660 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
661
662 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
663 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
664 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
665 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
666 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
667 overhead is very small. */
668 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
669 && desired_row->full_width_p
670 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
671 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
672 width != 0)
673 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
674 height > 0))
675 {
676 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
677
678 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
679 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
680 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
681 y -= width;
682
683 BLOCK_INPUT;
684 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
685 0, y, width, height, False);
686 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
687 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
688 y, width, height, False);
689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
690 }
691 }
692
693 static void
694 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
695 struct window *w;
696 struct glyph_row *row;
697 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
698 {
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
701 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
702 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
703 struct face *face = p->face;
704 int rowY;
705
706 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
707 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
708 if (p->y < rowY)
709 {
710 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
711 visible last row. */
712 int oldY = row->y;
713 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
714 row->visible_height = p->h;
715 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
716 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 row->y = oldY;
718 row->visible_height = oldVH;
719 }
720 else
721 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
722
723 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
724 {
725 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
726 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
727 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
728 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
729 if (face->stipple)
730 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
731 else
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
733
734 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
735 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
736
737 if (!face->stipple)
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
739 }
740
741 if (p->which)
742 {
743 unsigned char *bits;
744 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
745 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
746 XGCValues gcv;
747
748 if (p->wd > 8)
749 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
750 else
751 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
752
753 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
754 by the server. */
755 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
756 (p->cursor_p
757 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
758 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
759 : face->foreground),
760 face->background, depth);
761
762 if (p->overlay_p)
763 {
764 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
766 bits, p->wd, p->h,
767 1, 0, 1);
768 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
769 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
770 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
771 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
772 }
773
774 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
775 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
776 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
777
778 if (p->overlay_p)
779 {
780 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
781 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
782 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
783 }
784 }
785
786 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
787 }
788
789 \f
790
791 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
792 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
793 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
794 rarely happens). */
795
796 static void
797 XTset_terminal_modes ()
798 {
799 }
800
801 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
802 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
803
804 static void
805 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
806 {
807 }
808
809
810 \f
811 /***********************************************************************
812 Display Iterator
813 ***********************************************************************/
814
815 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
816
817 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
818
819
820 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
821 is not contained in the font. */
822
823 static XCharStruct *
824 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
825 XFontStruct *font;
826 XChar2b *char2b;
827 int font_type; /* unused on X */
828 {
829 /* The result metric information. */
830 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
831
832 xassert (font && char2b);
833
834 if (font->per_char != NULL)
835 {
836 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
837 {
838 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
839 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
840 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
841 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
842 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
843 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
844 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
845 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
846 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
847 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
848 }
849 else
850 {
851 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
852 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
853 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
854 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
855
856 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
857 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
858
859 where:
860
861 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
862 / = integer division
863 \ = integer modulus */
864 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
865 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
866 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
867 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
868 {
869 pcm = (font->per_char
870 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
871 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
872 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
873 }
874 }
875 }
876 else
877 {
878 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
879 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
880 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
881 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
882 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
883 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
884 }
885
886 return ((pcm == NULL
887 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
888 ? NULL : pcm);
889 }
890
891
892 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
893 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
894
895 static int
896 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
897 int c;
898 XChar2b *char2b;
899 struct font_info *font_info;
900 int *two_byte_p;
901 {
902 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
903 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
904
905 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
906 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
907 fixed encoding. */
908 if (font_info->font_encoder)
909 {
910 /* It's a program. */
911 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
912
913 check_ccl_update (ccl);
914 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
915 {
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
918 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
919 }
920 else
921 {
922 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
923 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
924 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
925 }
926
927 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
928
929 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
930 program. */
931 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
932 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
933 else
934 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
935 }
936 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
937 {
938 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
939 encoding numbers. */
940 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
941
942 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
943 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
944 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
945
946 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
947 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
948 }
949
950 if (two_byte_p)
951 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
952
953 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
954 }
955
956
957 \f
958 /***********************************************************************
959 Glyph display
960 ***********************************************************************/
961
962
963
964 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
967 int));
968 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
977 unsigned long *, double, int));
978 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
979 double, int, unsigned long));
980 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
981 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
985 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
986 int, int, int));
987 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
988 int, int, int, int, int, int,
989 XRectangle *));
990 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
991 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
992
993 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
994 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
995 #endif
996
997
998 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
999 face. */
1000
1001 static void
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1003 struct glyph_string *s;
1004 {
1005 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1006 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1007 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && !s->cmp)
1009 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1010 else
1011 {
1012 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1013 XGCValues xgcv;
1014 unsigned long mask;
1015
1016 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1018
1019 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1020 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1021 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1023 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1024 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026
1027 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1028 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1029 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1030 {
1031 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1032 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1033 }
1034
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1039
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1046
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1048 }
1049 }
1050
1051
1052 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1056 struct glyph_string *s;
1057 {
1058 int face_id;
1059 struct face *face;
1060
1061 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1062 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1063 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1064 if (face == NULL)
1065 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1066
1067 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1068 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1069 else
1070 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1071 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1072 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1073
1074 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1075 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 else
1078 {
1079 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1080 but font FONT. */
1081 XGCValues xgcv;
1082 unsigned long mask;
1083
1084 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1085 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1086 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1087 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1088 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1089 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1090
1091 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1092 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1093 mask, &xgcv);
1094 else
1095 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1096 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1097
1098 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1099 }
1100
1101 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1102 }
1103
1104
1105 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1106 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1107 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1108
1109 static INLINE void
1110 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1111 struct glyph_string *s;
1112 {
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1118 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1119 pattern. */
1120
1121 static INLINE void
1122 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1123 struct glyph_string *s;
1124 {
1125 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1126
1127 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1128 {
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1133 {
1134 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1138 {
1139 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1143 {
1144 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1146 }
1147 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1148 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1156 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1157 }
1158
1159 /* GC must have been set. */
1160 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1161 }
1162
1163
1164 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1165 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1166
1167 static INLINE void
1168 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1169 struct glyph_string *s;
1170 {
1171 XRectangle r;
1172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1173 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1174 }
1175
1176
1177 /* RIF:
1178 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1179 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1180
1181 static void
1182 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1183 struct glyph_string *s;
1184 {
1185 if (s->cmp == NULL
1186 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1187 {
1188 XCharStruct cs;
1189 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1190 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1191 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1192 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1193 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1194 }
1195 }
1196
1197
1198 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1199
1200 static INLINE void
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1202 struct glyph_string *s;
1203 int x, y, w, h;
1204 {
1205 XGCValues xgcv;
1206 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1207 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1208 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1209 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1210 }
1211
1212
1213 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1214 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1215 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1216 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1217 contains the first component of a composition. */
1218
1219 static void
1220 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1221 struct glyph_string *s;
1222 int force_p;
1223 {
1224 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1225 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1226 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1227 {
1228 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1229
1230 if (s->stippled_p)
1231 {
1232 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1234 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1235 s->y + box_line_width,
1236 s->background_width,
1237 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1238 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1239 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1240 }
1241 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1242 || s->font_not_found_p
1243 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1244 || force_p)
1245 {
1246 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 }
1253
1254
1255 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1256
1257 static void
1258 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1259 struct glyph_string *s;
1260 {
1261 int i, x;
1262
1263 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1264 of S to the right of that box line. */
1265 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1266 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1267 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1268 else
1269 x = s->x;
1270
1271 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1272 loaded. */
1273 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1274 {
1275 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1276 {
1277 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1279 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1280 s->height - 1);
1281 x += g->pixel_width;
1282 }
1283 }
1284 else
1285 {
1286 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1287 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1288
1289 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1290 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1291
1292 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1293 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1294 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1295 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1296
1297 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1298 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1299 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1300 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1301 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1302 if (s->for_overlaps
1303 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1304 {
1305 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1306 if (s->two_byte_p)
1307 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1308 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1309 else
1310 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1312 }
1313 else
1314 {
1315 if (s->two_byte_p)
1316 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1317 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1318 else
1319 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1320 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1321 }
1322
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 {
1325 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1326 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1327 if (s->two_byte_p)
1328 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1329 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1330 else
1331 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1332 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1333 }
1334 }
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1338
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1341 struct glyph_string *s;
1342 {
1343 int i, x;
1344
1345 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1346 of S to the right of that box line. */
1347 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1348 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1349 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1350 else
1351 x = s->x;
1352
1353 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1354 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1355 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1356 this composition. */
1357
1358 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1359 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1360 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1361 {
1362 if (s->gidx == 0)
1363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1364 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1365 }
1366 else
1367 {
1368 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1369 {
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 if (s->face->overstrike)
1375 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1376 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1377 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1378 s->char2b + i, 1);
1379 }
1380 }
1381 }
1382
1383
1384 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1385
1386 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1387 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1388 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1389 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1390 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1391
1392
1393 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1394 cannot be determined. */
1395
1396 static struct frame *
1397 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1398 Widget widget;
1399 {
1400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1401 Lisp_Object tail;
1402 struct frame *f;
1403
1404 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1405
1406 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1407 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1408 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1409 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1410 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1411 widget = XtParent (widget);
1412
1413 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1414 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1415 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1416 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1417 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1418 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1419 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1420 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1421 return f;
1422
1423 abort ();
1424 }
1425
1426
1427 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1428 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1429 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1430 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1431
1432 int
1433 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1434 Widget widget;
1435 Colormap cmap;
1436 XColor *color;
1437 {
1438 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1439 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1440 }
1441
1442
1443 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1444 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1445 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1446 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1447 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1448 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1449
1450 int
1451 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1452 Widget widget;
1453 Display *display;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 unsigned long *pixel;
1456 double factor;
1457 int delta;
1458 {
1459 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1460 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1461 }
1462
1463
1464 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1465 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1466
1467 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1468 {
1469 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1470 sizeof (Screen *)},
1471 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1472 sizeof (Colormap)}
1473 };
1474
1475
1476 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1477 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1478
1479 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1480
1481
1482 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1483
1484 DPY is the display we are working on.
1485
1486 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1487 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1488 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1489 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1490
1491 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1492 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1493
1494 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1495 we allocated the color or not.
1496
1497 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1498
1499 static Boolean
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1501 Display *dpy;
1502 XrmValue *args;
1503 Cardinal *nargs;
1504 XrmValue *from, *to;
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1506 {
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1512
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1514 {
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1520 }
1521
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1525
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1532 {
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 }
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1538 {
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1541 }
1542 else
1543 {
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1546
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1556 {
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1558 {
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1561 }
1562
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1564 }
1565 else
1566 {
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1569 }
1570
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1573 }
1574
1575
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1579
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1581
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1585
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1587
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1590 XtAppContext app;
1591 XrmValuePtr to;
1592 XtPointer closure;
1593 XrmValuePtr args;
1594 Cardinal *nargs;
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1624 Display *dpy;
1625 int *ncells;
1626 {
1627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1628
1629 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1630 {
1631 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1632 int i;
1633
1634 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1635 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells
1637 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1638 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1639
1640 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1642
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1645 }
1646
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 }
1650
1651
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1654
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1657 struct frame *f;
1658 XColor *colors;
1659 int ncolors;
1660 {
1661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1662
1663 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1664 {
1665 int i;
1666 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1667 {
1668 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1669 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1670 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1671 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1672 }
1673 }
1674 else
1675 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 }
1677
1678
1679 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1680 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1681
1682 void
1683 x_query_color (f, color)
1684 struct frame *f;
1685 XColor *color;
1686 {
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1698 Display *dpy;
1699 Colormap cmap;
1700 XColor *color;
1701 {
1702 int rc;
1703
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1706 {
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1715
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1717 {
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1722
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1724 {
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1727 }
1728 }
1729
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1742
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1748 {
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1759
1760 return rc;
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1768
1769 int
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1771 struct frame *f;
1772 Colormap cmap;
1773 XColor *color;
1774 {
1775 gamma_correct (f, color);
1776 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1777 }
1778
1779
1780 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1781 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1782 get color reference counts right. */
1783
1784 unsigned long
1785 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1786 struct frame *f;
1787 unsigned long pixel;
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1806
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1809 Display *dpy;
1810 Colormap cmap;
1811 unsigned long pixel;
1812 {
1813 XColor color;
1814
1815 color.pixel = pixel;
1816 BLOCK_INPUT;
1817 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1818 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1820 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1821 register_color (pixel);
1822 #endif
1823 return color.pixel;
1824 }
1825
1826
1827 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1828 boosted.
1829
1830 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1831 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1832 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1833 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1834 use an additional additive factor.
1835
1836 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1837 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1838 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1839
1840
1841 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1842 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1843 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1844 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1845 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1846 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1847
1848 static int
1849 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1850 struct frame *f;
1851 Display *display;
1852 Colormap cmap;
1853 unsigned long *pixel;
1854 double factor;
1855 int delta;
1856 {
1857 XColor color, new;
1858 long bright;
1859 int success_p;
1860
1861 /* Get RGB color values. */
1862 color.pixel = *pixel;
1863 x_query_color (f, &color);
1864
1865 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1866 xassert (factor >= 0);
1867 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1868 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1869 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1870
1871 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1872 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1873
1874 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1875 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1876 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1877 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1878 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1879 {
1880 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1881 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1882 /* The additive adjustment. */
1883 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1884
1885 if (factor < 1)
1886 {
1887 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1888 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1889 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1890 }
1891 else
1892 {
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1896 }
1897 }
1898
1899 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1900 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 if (success_p)
1902 {
1903 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1904 {
1905 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1906 delta to the RGB values. */
1907 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1908
1909 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1910 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1911 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1912 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1913 }
1914 else
1915 success_p = 1;
1916 *pixel = new.pixel;
1917 }
1918
1919 return success_p;
1920 }
1921
1922
1923 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1924 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1925 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1926 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1927 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1928 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1929
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1932 struct frame *f;
1933 struct relief *relief;
1934 double factor;
1935 int delta;
1936 unsigned long default_pixel;
1937 {
1938 XGCValues xgcv;
1939 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1940 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1941 unsigned long pixel;
1942 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1943 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1945 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1946
1947 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1948 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1949
1950 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1951 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1952 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1953 if (relief->gc
1954 && relief->allocated_p)
1955 {
1956 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1957 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Allocate new color. */
1961 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1962 pixel = background;
1963 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1964 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1965 {
1966 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1967 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1968 }
1969
1970 if (relief->gc == 0)
1971 {
1972 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1973 mask |= GCStipple;
1974 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1975 }
1976 else
1977 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1982
1983 static void
1984 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1985 struct glyph_string *s;
1986 {
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1989
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1997 {
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
1999
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2003 }
2004
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2007 {
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2013 }
2014 }
2015
2016
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2027 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2028 struct frame *f;
2029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2030 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2031 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2032 {
2033 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2034 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2035 int i;
2036 GC gc;
2037
2038 if (raised_p)
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2040 else
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2043
2044 /* Top. */
2045 if (top_p)
2046 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2049 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2050
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2054 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2055 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2056
2057 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2058 if (raised_p)
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2060 else
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2062 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2063
2064 /* Bottom. */
2065 if (bot_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2069 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2076
2077 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2078 }
2079
2080
2081 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2082 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2083 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2084 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2085 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2086 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2087
2088 static void
2089 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2090 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2091 struct glyph_string *s;
2092 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2093 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2094 {
2095 XGCValues xgcv;
2096
2097 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2100
2101 /* Top. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104
2105 /* Left. */
2106 if (left_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109
2110 /* Bottom. */
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2113
2114 /* Right. */
2115 if (right_p)
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2118
2119 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2120 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2121 }
2122
2123
2124 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2125
2126 static void
2127 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2128 struct glyph_string *s;
2129 {
2130 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2131 int left_p, right_p;
2132 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2133 XRectangle clip_rect;
2134
2135 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2136 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2137 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2138
2139 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2140 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2141 ? s->first_glyph
2142 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2143
2144 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2145 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2146 left_x = s->x;
2147 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2148 ? last_x - 1
2149 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2150 top_y = s->y;
2151 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2152
2153 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2154 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2155 && (s->prev == NULL
2156 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2157 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2158 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2159 && (s->next == NULL
2160 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2161
2162 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2163
2164 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2165 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2166 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2167 else
2168 {
2169 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2170 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2171 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2172 }
2173 }
2174
2175
2176 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2177
2178 static void
2179 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2180 struct glyph_string *s;
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int r = s->img->relief;
2252 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - r, y - r,
2255 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2271 struct glyph_string *s;
2272 {
2273 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 x0 = x - thick;
2305 y0 = y - thick;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2308
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2317 }
2318
2319
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2321
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2324 struct glyph_string *s;
2325 Pixmap pixmap;
2326 {
2327 int x = 0;
2328 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2329
2330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2331 right of that line. */
2332 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2334 && s->slice.x == 0)
2335 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2336
2337 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2338 by that margin. */
2339 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2340 x += s->img->hmargin;
2341 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2342 y += s->img->vmargin;
2343
2344 if (s->img->pixmap)
2345 {
2346 if (s->img->mask)
2347 {
2348 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2349 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2350 trust on the shape extension to be available
2351 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2352 manually. */
2353 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2354 | GCFunction);
2355 XGCValues xgcv;
2356
2357 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2358 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2359 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2360 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2361 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2362
2363 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2364 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2365 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2367 }
2368 else
2369 {
2370 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2371 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2372 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2373
2374 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2375 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2376 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2377 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2378 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2379 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2380 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2381 {
2382 int r = s->img->relief;
2383 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2384 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2385 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2386 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2387 }
2388 }
2389 }
2390 else
2391 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2392 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2393 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2394 }
2395
2396
2397 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2398 give the rectangle to draw. */
2399
2400 static void
2401 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2402 struct glyph_string *s;
2403 int x, y, w, h;
2404 {
2405 if (s->stippled_p)
2406 {
2407 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2408 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2409 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2411 }
2412 else
2413 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2418
2419 s->y
2420 s->x +-------------------------
2421 | s->face->box
2422 |
2423 | +-------------------------
2424 | | s->img->margin
2425 | |
2426 | | +-------------------
2427 | | | the image
2428
2429 */
2430
2431 static void
2432 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2433 struct glyph_string *s;
2434 {
2435 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2436 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2437 int height;
2438 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2439
2440 height = s->height;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2443 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2444 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2445
2446 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2447 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2448 flickering. */
2449 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2450 if (height > s->slice.height
2451 || s->img->hmargin
2452 || s->img->vmargin
2453 || s->img->mask
2454 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2455 || s->width != s->background_width)
2456 {
2457 if (s->img->mask)
2458 {
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2460 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2461 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2462 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2463 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2464
2465 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2466 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2467 s->background_width,
2468 s->height, depth);
2469
2470 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2471 pixmap. */
2472 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2473
2474 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2475 if (s->stippled_p)
2476 {
2477 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2478 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2482 }
2483 else
2484 {
2485 XGCValues xgcv;
2486 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2487 &xgcv);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2492 }
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 int x = s->x;
2497 int y = s->y;
2498
2499 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2500 && s->slice.x == 0)
2501 x += box_line_hwidth;
2502
2503 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2504 y += box_line_vwidth;
2505
2506 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2507 }
2508
2509 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2510 }
2511
2512 /* Draw the foreground. */
2513 if (pixmap != None)
2514 {
2515 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2516 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2517 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2519 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2520 }
2521 else
2522 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2523
2524 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2525 if (s->img->relief
2526 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2528 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2529 }
2530
2531
2532 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2533
2534 static void
2535 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2536 struct glyph_string *s;
2537 {
2538 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2539 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2540
2541 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2542 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2543 {
2544 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2545 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2546 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2547
2548 /* Draw cursor. */
2549 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2550
2551 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2552 if (width < s->background_width)
2553 {
2554 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2555 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2556 XRectangle r;
2557 GC gc;
2558
2559 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2560 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2561 {
2562 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2563 gc = s->gc;
2564 }
2565 else
2566 gc = s->face->gc;
2567
2568 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2569 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2570
2571 if (s->face->stipple)
2572 {
2573 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2574 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2575 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2576 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 {
2580 XGCValues xgcv;
2581 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2582 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2583 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2584 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2585 }
2586 }
2587 }
2588 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2589 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2590 s->height);
2591
2592 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2597
2598 static void
2599 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2600 struct glyph_string *s;
2601 {
2602 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2603
2604 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2605 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2606 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2607 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2608 {
2609 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2610 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2613 }
2614
2615 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2616 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2617
2618 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2619 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2620 if (!s->for_overlaps
2621 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2622 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2623 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2624
2625 {
2626 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2627 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2629 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2630 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2631 }
2632 else
2633 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2634
2635 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2636 {
2637 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2638 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2639 break;
2640
2641 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2642 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2643 break;
2644
2645 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2646 if (s->for_overlaps)
2647 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2648 else
2649 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2651 break;
2652
2653 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2654 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2655 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2656 else
2657 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2658 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2659 break;
2660
2661 default:
2662 abort ();
2663 }
2664
2665 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2666 {
2667 /* Draw underline. */
2668 if (s->face->underline_p)
2669 {
2670 unsigned long tem, h;
2671 int y;
2672
2673 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2674 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2675 h = 1;
2676
2677 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2678 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2679 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2680 specs, and its default is
2681
2682 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2683 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2684
2685 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2686 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2687 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2688 else if (s->face->font)
2689 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2690 else
2691 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2692
2693 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2694 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2695 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2696 else
2697 {
2698 XGCValues xgcv;
2699 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2700 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2701 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2702 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2703 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2704 }
2705 }
2706
2707 /* Draw overline. */
2708 if (s->face->overline_p)
2709 {
2710 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2711
2712 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2713 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2714 s->width, h);
2715 else
2716 {
2717 XGCValues xgcv;
2718 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2719 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2720 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2721 s->width, h);
2722 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2723 }
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Draw strike-through. */
2727 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2728 {
2729 unsigned long h = 1;
2730 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2731
2732 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2733 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2734 s->width, h);
2735 else
2736 {
2737 XGCValues xgcv;
2738 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2739 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2740 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2741 s->width, h);
2742 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2743 }
2744 }
2745
2746 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2747 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2748 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2749 }
2750
2751 /* Reset clipping. */
2752 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2753 }
2754
2755 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2756
2757 void
2758 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2759 struct frame *f;
2760 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2761 {
2762 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2763 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2764 x, y, width, height,
2765 x + shift_by, y);
2766 }
2767
2768 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2769 for X frames. */
2770
2771 static void
2772 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2773 register int n;
2774 {
2775 abort ();
2776 }
2777
2778
2779 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2780 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2781
2782 void
2783 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2784 Display *dpy;
2785 Window window;
2786 int x, y;
2787 int width, height;
2788 int exposures;
2789 {
2790 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2791 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2792 }
2793
2794
2795 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2796 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2797
2798 static void
2799 x_clear_frame ()
2800 {
2801 struct frame *f;
2802
2803 if (updating_frame)
2804 f = updating_frame;
2805 else
2806 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2807
2808 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2809 longer visible. */
2810 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2811 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2812 output_cursor.x = -1;
2813
2814 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2815 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2816 BLOCK_INPUT;
2817 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2818
2819 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2820 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2821 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2822
2823 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2824
2825 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2826 }
2827
2828
2829 \f
2830 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2831
2832 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2833 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2834
2835 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2836
2837
2838 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2839 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2840
2841 static int
2842 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2843 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2844 {
2845 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2846 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2847 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2848 {
2849 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2850 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2851 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2852 }
2853
2854 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2855 {
2856 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2857 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2858 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2859 }
2860
2861 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2862 positive. */
2863 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2864 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2865
2866 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2867 negative. */
2868 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2869 }
2870
2871 void
2872 XTflash (f)
2873 struct frame *f;
2874 {
2875 BLOCK_INPUT;
2876
2877 {
2878 GC gc;
2879
2880 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2881 pixels into background pixels. */
2882 {
2883 XGCValues values;
2884
2885 values.function = GXxor;
2886 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2887 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2888
2889 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2890 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2891 }
2892
2893 {
2894 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2895 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2896 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2897 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2898 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2899 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2900 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901
2902 int width;
2903
2904 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2905 edge it is next to. */
2906 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2907 {
2908 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2909 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2910 break;
2911
2912 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2913 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2914 break;
2915
2916 default:
2917 break;
2918 }
2919
2920 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2921
2922 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2923 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2924 {
2925 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2926 flash_left,
2927 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2928 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2929 width, flash_height);
2930 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2931 flash_left,
2932 (height - flash_height
2933 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2934 width, flash_height);
2935 }
2936 else
2937 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2938 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2939 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2940 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2941
2942 x_flush (f);
2943
2944 {
2945 struct timeval wakeup;
2946
2947 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2948
2949 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2950 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2951 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2952 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2953
2954 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2955 available. */
2956 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2957 {
2958 struct timeval current;
2959 struct timeval timeout;
2960
2961 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2962
2963 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2964 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2965 break;
2966
2967 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2968 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2969 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2970
2971 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2972 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2973 }
2974 }
2975
2976 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2977 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2978 {
2979 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2980 flash_left,
2981 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2982 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2983 width, flash_height);
2984 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2985 flash_left,
2986 (height - flash_height
2987 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2988 width, flash_height);
2989 }
2990 else
2991 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2992 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2993 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2994 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2995
2996 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2997 x_flush (f);
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3002 }
3003
3004 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3005
3006
3007 /* Make audible bell. */
3008
3009 void
3010 XTring_bell ()
3011 {
3012 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3013
3014 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3015 {
3016 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3017 if (visible_bell)
3018 XTflash (f);
3019 else
3020 #endif
3021 {
3022 BLOCK_INPUT;
3023 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3024 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3025 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3026 }
3027 }
3028 }
3029
3030 \f
3031 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3032 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3033 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3034 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3035
3036 static void
3037 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3038 register int n;
3039 {
3040 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3041 }
3042
3043
3044 \f
3045 /***********************************************************************
3046 Line Dance
3047 ***********************************************************************/
3048
3049 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3050 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3051
3052 static void
3053 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3054 int vpos, n;
3055 {
3056 abort ();
3057 }
3058
3059
3060 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3061
3062 static void
3063 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3064 struct window *w;
3065 struct run *run;
3066 {
3067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3068 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3069
3070 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3071 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3072 fringe of W. */
3073 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3074
3075 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3076 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3077 bottom_y = y + height;
3078
3079 if (to_y < from_y)
3080 {
3081 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3082 line at the bottom. */
3083 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3084 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3085 else
3086 height = run->height;
3087 }
3088 else
3089 {
3090 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3091 at the bottom. */
3092 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3093 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3094 else
3095 height = run->height;
3096 }
3097
3098 BLOCK_INPUT;
3099
3100 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3101 updated_window = w;
3102 x_clear_cursor (w);
3103
3104 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3105 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3106 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3107 x, from_y,
3108 width, height,
3109 x, to_y);
3110
3111 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3112 }
3113
3114
3115 \f
3116 /***********************************************************************
3117 Exposure Events
3118 ***********************************************************************/
3119
3120 \f
3121 static void
3122 frame_highlight (f)
3123 struct frame *f;
3124 {
3125 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3126 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3127 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3128 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3129 BLOCK_INPUT;
3130 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3131 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3132 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3133 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3134 }
3135
3136 static void
3137 frame_unhighlight (f)
3138 struct frame *f;
3139 {
3140 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3141 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3142 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3143 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3144 BLOCK_INPUT;
3145 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3146 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3148 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3149 }
3150
3151 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3152 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3153 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3154 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3155 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3156
3157 static void
3158 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3159 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3160 struct frame *frame;
3161 {
3162 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3163
3164 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3165 {
3166 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3167 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3168 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3169
3170 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3171 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3172
3173 #if 0
3174 selected_frame = frame;
3175 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3176 selected_frame);
3177 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3178 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3179 #endif /* ! 0 */
3180
3181 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3182 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3183 else
3184 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3185 }
3186
3187 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3188 }
3189
3190 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3191 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3192 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3193
3194 static void
3195 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3196 int type;
3197 int state;
3198 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3199 struct frame *frame;
3200 struct input_event *bufp;
3201 {
3202 if (type == FocusIn)
3203 {
3204 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3205 {
3206 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3207 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3208
3209 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3210 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3211 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3212 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3213 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3214 {
3215 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3216 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3217 }
3218 }
3219
3220 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3221
3222 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3223 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3224 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3225 #endif
3226 }
3227 else if (type == FocusOut)
3228 {
3229 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3230
3231 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3232 {
3233 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3234 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3235 }
3236
3237 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3238 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3239 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3240 #endif
3241 }
3242 }
3243
3244 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3245 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3246
3247 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3248
3249 static void
3250 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3251 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3252 XEvent *event;
3253 struct input_event *bufp;
3254 {
3255 struct frame *frame;
3256
3257 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3258 if (! frame)
3259 return;
3260
3261 switch (event->type)
3262 {
3263 case EnterNotify:
3264 case LeaveNotify:
3265 {
3266 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3267 int focus_state
3268 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3269
3270 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3271 && event->xcrossing.focus
3272 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3273 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3274 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3275 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3276 }
3277 break;
3278
3279 case FocusIn:
3280 case FocusOut:
3281 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3282 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3283 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3284 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3285 break;
3286 }
3287 }
3288
3289
3290 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3291
3292 void
3293 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3294 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3295 {
3296 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3297 }
3298
3299 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3300 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3301 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3302
3303 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3304 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3305 the appropriate X display info. */
3306
3307 static void
3308 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3309 struct frame *frame;
3310 {
3311 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3312 }
3313
3314 static void
3315 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3316 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3317 {
3318 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3319
3320 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3321 {
3322 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3323 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3324 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3325 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3326 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3327 {
3328 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3329 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3330 }
3331 }
3332 else
3333 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3334
3335 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3336 {
3337 if (old_highlight)
3338 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3339 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3340 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3341 }
3342 }
3343
3344
3345 \f
3346 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3347
3348 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3349 static void
3350 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3351 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3352 {
3353 int min_code, max_code;
3354 KeySym *syms;
3355 int syms_per_code;
3356 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3357
3358 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3359 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3363
3364 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3365 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3366 #else
3367 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3368 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3369 #endif
3370
3371 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3372 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3373 &syms_per_code);
3374 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3375
3376 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3377 Alt keysyms are on. */
3378 {
3379 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3380 int found_alt_or_meta;
3381
3382 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3383 {
3384 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3385 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3386 {
3387 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3388
3389 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3390 if (code == 0)
3391 continue;
3392
3393 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3394 {
3395 int code_col;
3396
3397 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3398 {
3399 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3400
3401 switch (sym)
3402 {
3403 case XK_Meta_L:
3404 case XK_Meta_R:
3405 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3406 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3407 break;
3408
3409 case XK_Alt_L:
3410 case XK_Alt_R:
3411 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3412 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3413 break;
3414
3415 case XK_Hyper_L:
3416 case XK_Hyper_R:
3417 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3418 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3419 code_col = syms_per_code;
3420 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3421 break;
3422
3423 case XK_Super_L:
3424 case XK_Super_R:
3425 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3426 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3427 code_col = syms_per_code;
3428 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3429 break;
3430
3431 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3432 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3433 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3434 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3435 code_col = syms_per_code;
3436 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3437 break;
3438 }
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444
3445 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3446 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3447 {
3448 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3449 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3450 }
3451
3452 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3453 make them just meta, not alt. */
3454 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3455 {
3456 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3457 }
3458
3459 XFree ((char *) syms);
3460 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3461 }
3462
3463 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3464 Emacs uses. */
3465
3466 unsigned int
3467 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3469 unsigned int state;
3470 {
3471 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3475 Lisp_Object tem;
3476
3477 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3478 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3479 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3480 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3481 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3482 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3483 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3484 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3485
3486
3487 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3488 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3493 }
3494
3495 static unsigned int
3496 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3498 unsigned int state;
3499 {
3500 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3504
3505 Lisp_Object tem;
3506
3507 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3508 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3509 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3510 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3511 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3512 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3513 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3514 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3515
3516
3517 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3518 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3521 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3523 }
3524
3525 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3526
3527 char *
3528 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3529 KeySym keysym;
3530 {
3531 char *value;
3532
3533 BLOCK_INPUT;
3534 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3536
3537 return value;
3538 }
3539
3540
3541 \f
3542 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3543
3544 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3545
3546 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3547 the mouse. */
3548
3549 static Lisp_Object
3550 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3551 struct input_event *result;
3552 XButtonEvent *event;
3553 struct frame *f;
3554 {
3555 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3556 otherwise. */
3557 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3558 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3559 result->timestamp = event->time;
3560 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3561 event->state)
3562 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3563 ? up_modifier
3564 : down_modifier));
3565
3566 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3567 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3568 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3569 result->arg = Qnil;
3570 return Qnil;
3571 }
3572
3573 \f
3574 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3575 The input handler calls this.
3576
3577 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3578 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3579 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3580 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3581
3582 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3583 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3584
3585 static int
3586 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3587 FRAME_PTR frame;
3588 XMotionEvent *event;
3589 {
3590 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3591 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3592 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3593
3594 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3595 return 0;
3596
3597 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3598 {
3599 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3600 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3601 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3602 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3603 return 1;
3604 }
3605
3606
3607 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3608 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3609 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3610 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3611 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3612 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3613 {
3614 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3615 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3616 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3617 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3618 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3619 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3620 return 1;
3621 }
3622
3623 return 0;
3624 }
3625
3626 \f
3627 /************************************************************************
3628 Mouse Face
3629 ************************************************************************/
3630
3631 static void
3632 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3633 {
3634 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3635 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3636 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3637 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3638 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3639 }
3640
3641
3642
3643 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3644 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3645
3646 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3647 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3648 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3649 position on the scroll bar.
3650
3651 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3652 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3653 the mouse is over.
3654
3655 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3656 was at this position.
3657
3658 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3659
3660 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3661 movement. */
3662
3663 static void
3664 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3665 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3666 int insist;
3667 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3668 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3669 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3670 unsigned long *time;
3671 {
3672 FRAME_PTR f1;
3673
3674 BLOCK_INPUT;
3675
3676 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3677 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3678 else
3679 {
3680 Window root;
3681 int root_x, root_y;
3682
3683 Window dummy_window;
3684 int dummy;
3685
3686 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3687
3688 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3689 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3690 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3691 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3692
3693 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3694
3695 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3696 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3697 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3698
3699 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3700 &root,
3701
3702 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3703 a different screen. */
3704 &dummy_window,
3705
3706 /* The position on that root window. */
3707 &root_x, &root_y,
3708
3709 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3710 &dummy, &dummy,
3711
3712 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3713 we don't care. */
3714 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3715
3716 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3717 containing the pointer. */
3718 {
3719 Window win, child;
3720 int win_x, win_y;
3721 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3722
3723 win = root;
3724
3725 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3726 structure is changing at the same time this function
3727 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3728
3729 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3730
3731 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3732 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3733 {
3734 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3735 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3736 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3737
3738 /* From-window, to-window. */
3739 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3740
3741 /* From-position, to-position. */
3742 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3743
3744 /* Child of win. */
3745 &child);
3746 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3747 }
3748 else
3749 {
3750 while (1)
3751 {
3752 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3753
3754 /* From-window, to-window. */
3755 root, win,
3756
3757 /* From-position, to-position. */
3758 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3759
3760 /* Child of win. */
3761 &child);
3762
3763 if (child == None || child == win)
3764 break;
3765
3766 win = child;
3767 parent_x = win_x;
3768 parent_y = win_y;
3769 }
3770
3771 /* Now we know that:
3772 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3773 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3774 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3775 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3776 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3777 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3778 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3779 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3780 never use them in that case.) */
3781
3782 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3783 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3784
3785 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3786 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3787 on the frame. */
3788 if (f1 != NULL
3789 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3790 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3791 f1 = NULL;
3792 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3793 }
3794
3795 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3796 f1 = 0;
3797
3798 x_uncatch_errors ();
3799
3800 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3801 if (! f1)
3802 {
3803 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3804
3805 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3806
3807 if (bar)
3808 {
3809 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3810 win_x = parent_x;
3811 win_y = parent_y;
3812 }
3813 }
3814
3815 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3816 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3817
3818 if (f1)
3819 {
3820 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3821 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3822 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3823 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3824 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3825 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3826 the frame are divided into. */
3827
3828 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3829 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3830
3831 *bar_window = Qnil;
3832 *part = 0;
3833 *fp = f1;
3834 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3835 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3836 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3837 }
3838 }
3839 }
3840
3841 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3842 }
3843
3844
3845 \f
3846 /***********************************************************************
3847 Scroll bars
3848 ***********************************************************************/
3849
3850 /* Scroll bar support. */
3851
3852 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3853 manages it.
3854 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3855 bits. */
3856
3857 static struct scroll_bar *
3858 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3859 Display *display;
3860 Window window_id;
3861 {
3862 Lisp_Object tail;
3863
3864 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3865 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3866 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3867
3868 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3869 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3870 tail = XCDR (tail))
3871 {
3872 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3873
3874 frame = XCAR (tail);
3875 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3876 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3877 abort ();
3878
3879 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3880 right window ID. */
3881 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3882 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3883 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3884 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3885 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3886 condemned = Qnil,
3887 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3888 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3889 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3890 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3891 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3892 }
3893
3894 return 0;
3895 }
3896
3897
3898 #if defined USE_LUCID
3899
3900 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3901 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3902
3903 static Widget
3904 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3905 Window window;
3906 {
3907 Lisp_Object tail;
3908
3909 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3910 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3911 tail = XCDR (tail))
3912 {
3913 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3914 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3915
3916 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3917 return menu_bar;
3918 }
3919
3920 return NULL;
3921 }
3922
3923 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3924
3925 \f
3926 /************************************************************************
3927 Toolkit scroll bars
3928 ************************************************************************/
3929
3930 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3931
3932 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3933 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3934 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3935 struct scroll_bar *));
3936 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3937 int, int, int));
3938
3939
3940 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3941 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3942
3943 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3944
3945 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3946
3947 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3948
3949 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3950 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3951
3952 #ifndef USE_GTK
3953 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3954
3955 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3956
3957 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3958
3959 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3960 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3961 to avoid jerkyness. */
3962
3963 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3964
3965 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3966 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3967 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3968 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3969
3970 static void
3971 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3972 num_params)
3973 Widget widget;
3974 XtPointer client_data;
3975 String action_name;
3976 XEvent *event;
3977 String *params;
3978 Cardinal *num_params;
3979 {
3980 int scroll_bar_p;
3981 char *end_action;
3982
3983 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3984 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3985 end_action = "Release";
3986 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3987 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3988 end_action = "EndScroll";
3989 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3990
3991 if (scroll_bar_p
3992 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3993 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3994 {
3995 struct window *w;
3996
3997 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3998 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3999 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4000
4001 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4002 {
4003 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4004 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4005 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4006 }
4007 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4008 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4009
4010 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4011 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4012 }
4013 }
4014 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4015
4016 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4017 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4018
4019 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4020 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4021
4022
4023 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4024 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4025 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4026 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4027
4028 static void
4029 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4030 Lisp_Object window;
4031 int part, portion, whole;
4032 {
4033 XEvent event;
4034 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4035 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4036 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4037 int i;
4038
4039 BLOCK_INPUT;
4040
4041 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4042 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4043 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4044 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4045 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4046 ev->format = 32;
4047
4048 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4049 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4050 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4051 into that array in the event. */
4052 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4053 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4054 break;
4055
4056 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4057 {
4058 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4059 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4060 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4061
4062 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4063 nbytes);
4064 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4065 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4066 }
4067
4068 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4069 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4070 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4071 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4072 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4073 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4074
4075 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4077
4078 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4079 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4080 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4081 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4082 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4083 }
4084
4085
4086 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4087 in *IEVENT. */
4088
4089 static void
4090 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4091 XEvent *event;
4092 struct input_event *ievent;
4093 {
4094 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 struct frame *f;
4097 struct window *w;
4098
4099 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4100 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4101
4102 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4103 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4104
4105 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4106 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4107 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4108 #ifdef USE_GTK
4109 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4110 #else
4111 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4112 #endif
4113 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4114 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4115 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4116 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4117 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4118 }
4119
4120
4121 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4122
4123 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4124
4125 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4126
4127
4128 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4129 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4130 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4131
4132 static void
4133 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4134 Widget widget;
4135 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4136 {
4137 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4138 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4139 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4140
4141 switch (cs->reason)
4142 {
4143 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4144 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4145 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4146 break;
4147
4148 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4149 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4150 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4151 break;
4152
4153 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4154 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4155 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4156 break;
4157
4158 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4159 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4160 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4161 break;
4162
4163 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4164 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4165 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4166 break;
4167
4168 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4169 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4170 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4171 break;
4172
4173 case XmCR_DRAG:
4174 {
4175 int slider_size;
4176
4177 /* Get the slider size. */
4178 BLOCK_INPUT;
4179 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4180 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4181
4182 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4183 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4184 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4185 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4186 }
4187 break;
4188
4189 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4190 break;
4191 };
4192
4193 if (part >= 0)
4194 {
4195 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4196 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4197 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4198 }
4199 }
4200
4201
4202 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4203 #ifdef USE_GTK
4204 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4205 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4206
4207 static void
4208 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4209 GtkRange *widget;
4210 gpointer data;
4211 {
4212 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4213 gdouble previous;
4214 gdouble position;
4215 gdouble *p;
4216 int diff;
4217
4218 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4219 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4220
4221 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4222
4223 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4224 if (! p)
4225 {
4226 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4227 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4228 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4229 }
4230
4231 previous = *p;
4232 *p = position;
4233
4234 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4235
4236 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4237
4238 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4239 {
4240 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4241 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4242 }
4243 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4244 {
4245 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4246 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4247 }
4248 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4249 {
4250 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4251 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4252 }
4253 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4254 {
4255 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4256 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4257 }
4258 else
4259 {
4260 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4261 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4262 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4263 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4264 }
4265
4266 if (part >= 0)
4267 {
4268 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4269 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4270 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4271 }
4272 }
4273
4274 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4275
4276 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4277 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4278 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4279 the thumb is. */
4280
4281 static void
4282 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4283 Widget widget;
4284 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4285 {
4286 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4287 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4288 float shown;
4289 int whole, portion, height;
4290 int part;
4291
4292 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4293 BLOCK_INPUT;
4294 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4295 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4296
4297 whole = 10000000;
4298 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4299
4300 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4301 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4302 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4303 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4304 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4305 bottom). */
4306 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4307 else
4308 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4309
4310 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4311 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4312 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4313 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4314 }
4315
4316
4317 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4318 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4319 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4320 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4321 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4322 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4323 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4324
4325 static void
4326 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4327 Widget widget;
4328 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4329 {
4330 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4331 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4332 int position = (long) call_data;
4333 Dimension height;
4334 int part;
4335
4336 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4337 BLOCK_INPUT;
4338 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4339 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4340
4341 if (abs (position) >= height)
4342 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4343
4344 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4345 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4346 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4347 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4348 else
4349 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4350
4351 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4354 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4355 }
4356
4357 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4358 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4359
4360 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4361
4362 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4363 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4364
4365 #ifdef USE_GTK
4366 static void
4367 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4368 struct frame *f;
4369 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4370 {
4371 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4372
4373 BLOCK_INPUT;
4374 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4375 scroll_bar_name);
4376 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4377 }
4378
4379 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4380
4381 static void
4382 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4383 struct frame *f;
4384 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4385 {
4386 Window xwindow;
4387 Widget widget;
4388 Arg av[20];
4389 int ac = 0;
4390 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4391 unsigned long pixel;
4392
4393 BLOCK_INPUT;
4394
4395 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4396 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4397 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4398 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4399 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4400 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4402 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4403 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4404
4405 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4406 if (pixel != -1)
4407 {
4408 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4409 ++ac;
4410 }
4411
4412 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4413 if (pixel != -1)
4414 {
4415 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4416 ++ac;
4417 }
4418
4419 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4420 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4421
4422 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4423 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4424 (XtPointer) bar);
4425 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4426 (XtPointer) bar);
4427 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4428 (XtPointer) bar);
4429 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4430 (XtPointer) bar);
4431 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4432 (XtPointer) bar);
4433 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4434 (XtPointer) bar);
4435 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4436 (XtPointer) bar);
4437
4438 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4439 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4440
4441 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4442 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4443 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4444 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4445
4446 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4447
4448 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4449 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4450 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4451 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4452 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4453 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4454 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4455 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4456
4457 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4458 if (pixel != -1)
4459 {
4460 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4461 ++ac;
4462 }
4463
4464 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4465 if (pixel != -1)
4466 {
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4468 ++ac;
4469 }
4470
4471 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4472
4473 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4474 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4475 {
4476 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4477 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4478 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4479 pixel = -1;
4480 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4481 }
4482 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4483 {
4484 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4485 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4486 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4487 pixel = -1;
4488 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4489 }
4490
4491 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4492 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4493 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4494 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4495 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4496 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4497 {
4498 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4499 ++ac;
4500 }
4501 else
4502 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4503 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4504 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4505 {
4506 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4507 the shadows. */
4508 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4509 ++ac;
4510
4511 /* Specify the colors. */
4512 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4513 if (pixel != -1)
4514 {
4515 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4516 ++ac;
4517 }
4518 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4519 if (pixel != -1)
4520 {
4521 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4522 ++ac;
4523 }
4524 }
4525 #endif
4526
4527 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4528 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4529
4530 {
4531 char *initial = "";
4532 char *val = initial;
4533 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4534 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4535 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4536 #endif
4537 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4538 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4539 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4540 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4541 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4542 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4543 }
4544 }
4545
4546 /* Define callbacks. */
4547 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4548 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4549 (XtPointer) bar);
4550
4551 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4552 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4553
4554 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4555
4556 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4557 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4558 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4559 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4560
4561 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4562 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4563 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4564 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4565
4566 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4567 }
4568 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4569
4570
4571 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4572 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4573
4574 #ifdef USE_GTK
4575 static void
4576 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4577 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4578 int portion, position, whole;
4579 {
4580 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4581 }
4582
4583 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4584 static void
4585 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4586 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4587 int portion, position, whole;
4588 {
4589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4590 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4591 float top, shown;
4592
4593 BLOCK_INPUT;
4594
4595 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4596
4597 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4598 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4599 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4600 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4601 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4602 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4603 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4604 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4605 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4606 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4607 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4608 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4609 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4610 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4611 whole += portion;
4612
4613 if (whole <= 0)
4614 top = 0, shown = 1;
4615 else
4616 {
4617 top = (float) position / whole;
4618 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4619 }
4620
4621 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4622 {
4623 int size, value;
4624
4625 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4626 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4627 value. */
4628 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4629 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4630 size = max (size, 1);
4631
4632 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4633 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4634 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4635
4636 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4637 }
4638 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4639
4640 if (whole == 0)
4641 top = 0, shown = 1;
4642 else
4643 {
4644 top = (float) position / whole;
4645 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4646 }
4647
4648 {
4649 float old_top, old_shown;
4650 Dimension height;
4651 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4652 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4653 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4654 XtNheight, &height,
4655 NULL);
4656
4657 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4658 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4659 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4660 else
4661 top = old_top;
4662 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4663 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4664
4665 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4666 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4667 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4668 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4669 {
4670 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4671 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4672 else
4673 {
4674 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4675 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4676 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4677
4678 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4679 }
4680 }
4681 }
4682 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4683
4684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4685 }
4686 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4687
4688 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4689
4690
4691 \f
4692 /************************************************************************
4693 Scroll bars, general
4694 ************************************************************************/
4695
4696 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4697 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4698 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4699 scroll bar. */
4700
4701 static struct scroll_bar *
4702 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4703 struct window *w;
4704 int top, left, width, height;
4705 {
4706 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4707 struct scroll_bar *bar
4708 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4709
4710 BLOCK_INPUT;
4711
4712 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4713 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4714 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4715 {
4716 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4717 unsigned long mask;
4718 Window window;
4719
4720 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4722 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4723
4724 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4725 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4726 | ExposureMask);
4727 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4728
4729 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4730
4731 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4732 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4733 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4734 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4735 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4736 left, top, width,
4737 window_box_height (w), False);
4738
4739 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4740 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4741 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4742 top,
4743 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4744 height,
4745 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4746 0,
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 CopyFromParent,
4750 /* Attributes. */
4751 mask, &a);
4752 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4753 }
4754 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4755
4756 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4757 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4758 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4759 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4760 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4761 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4762 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4763 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4764
4765 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4766 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4767 bar->prev = Qnil;
4768 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4769 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4770 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4771
4772 /* Map the window/widget. */
4773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4774 {
4775 #ifdef USE_GTK
4776 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4777 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4778 top,
4779 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4780 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4781 max (height, 1));
4782 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4783 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4784 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4785 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4786 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4787 top,
4788 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4789 max (height, 1), 0);
4790 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4791 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4792 }
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4794 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4795 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796
4797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4798 return bar;
4799 }
4800
4801
4802 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4803
4804 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4805 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4806 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4807 events.)
4808
4809 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4810 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4811 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4812 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4813 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4814
4815 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4816
4817 static void
4818 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4819 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4820 int start, end;
4821 int rebuild;
4822 {
4823 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4824 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4825 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4826 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4827
4828 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4829 if (! rebuild
4830 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4831 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4832 return;
4833
4834 BLOCK_INPUT;
4835
4836 {
4837 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4838 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4839 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4840
4841 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4842 the distance between start and end. */
4843 {
4844 int length = end - start;
4845
4846 if (start < 0)
4847 start = 0;
4848 else if (start > top_range)
4849 start = top_range;
4850 end = start + length;
4851
4852 if (end < start)
4853 end = start;
4854 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4855 end = top_range;
4856 }
4857
4858 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4859 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4860 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4861
4862 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4863 if (end > top_range)
4864 end = top_range;
4865
4866 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4867 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4868 that many pixels tall. */
4869 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4870
4871 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4872 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4873 if (0 < start)
4874 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4875 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4876 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4877 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4878 inside_width, start,
4879 False);
4880
4881 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4882 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4883 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4884 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4885
4886 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4887 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4888 /* x, y, width, height */
4889 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4890 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4891 inside_width, end - start);
4892
4893 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4894 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4895 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4896 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4897
4898 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4899 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4900 if (end < inside_height)
4901 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4902 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4904 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4905 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4906 False);
4907
4908 }
4909
4910 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4911 }
4912
4913 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4914
4915 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4916 nil. */
4917
4918 static void
4919 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4920 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4921 {
4922 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4923 BLOCK_INPUT;
4924
4925 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4926 #ifdef USE_GTK
4927 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4928 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4929 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4930 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4931 #else
4932 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4933 #endif
4934
4935 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4936 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4937
4938 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4939 }
4940
4941
4942 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4943 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4944 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4945 create one. */
4946
4947 static void
4948 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4949 struct window *w;
4950 int portion, whole, position;
4951 {
4952 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4953 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4954 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4955 int window_y, window_height;
4956
4957 /* Get window dimensions. */
4958 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4959 top = window_y;
4960 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4961 height = window_height;
4962
4963 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4964 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4965
4966 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4967 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4968 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4969 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4970 else
4971 sb_width = width;
4972
4973 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4974 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4975 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4976 sb_left = (left +
4977 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
4978 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
4979 : 0));
4980 else
4981 sb_left = (left +
4982 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
4983 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
4984 : width - sb_width));
4985 #else
4986 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4987 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4988 else
4989 sb_left = left;
4990 #endif
4991
4992 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4993 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4994 {
4995 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4996 {
4997 BLOCK_INPUT;
4998 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4999 left, top, width, height, False);
5000 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5001 }
5002
5003 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5004 }
5005 else
5006 {
5007 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5008 unsigned int mask = 0;
5009
5010 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5011
5012 BLOCK_INPUT;
5013
5014 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5015 mask |= CWX;
5016 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5017 mask |= CWY;
5018 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5019 mask |= CWWidth;
5020 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5021 mask |= CWHeight;
5022
5023 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5024
5025 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5026 if (mask)
5027 {
5028 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5029 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5030 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5031 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5032 left, top, width, height, False);
5033 #ifdef USE_GTK
5034 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5035 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5036 top,
5037 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5038 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5039 max (height, 1));
5040 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5041 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5042 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5043 top,
5044 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5045 max (height, 1), 0);
5046 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5047 }
5048 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5049
5050 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5051 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5052 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5053 {
5054 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5055 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5056 height, False);
5057 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5058 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5060 height, False);
5061 }
5062
5063 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5064 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5065 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5066 example. */
5067 {
5068 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5069 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5070 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5071 {
5072 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5073 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5074 left + area_width - rest, top,
5075 rest, height, False);
5076 else
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, rest, height, False);
5079 }
5080 }
5081
5082 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5083 if (mask)
5084 {
5085 XWindowChanges wc;
5086
5087 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5088 wc.y = top;
5089 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5090 wc.height = height;
5091 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5092 mask, &wc);
5093 }
5094
5095 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5096
5097 /* Remember new settings. */
5098 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5099 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5100 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5101 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5102
5103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5104 }
5105
5106 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5107 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5108 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5109 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5110 dragged. */
5111 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5112 {
5113 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5114
5115 if (whole == 0)
5116 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5117 else
5118 {
5119 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5120 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5121 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5122 }
5123 }
5124 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5125
5126 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5127 }
5128
5129
5130 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5131 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5132 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5133 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5134 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5135 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5136 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5137
5138 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5139 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5140 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5141
5142 static void
5143 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5144 FRAME_PTR frame;
5145 {
5146 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5147 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5148 {
5149 Lisp_Object bar;
5150 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5151 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5153 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5154 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5155 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5156 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5157 }
5158 }
5159
5160
5161 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5162 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5163
5164 static void
5165 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5166 struct window *window;
5167 {
5168 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5169 struct frame *f;
5170
5171 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5172 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5173 abort ();
5174
5175 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5176
5177 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5178 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5179 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5180 {
5181 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5182 the lists. */
5183 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5184 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5185 return;
5186 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5187 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5188 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5189 else
5190 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5191 one or the other! */
5192 abort ();
5193 }
5194 else
5195 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5196
5197 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5198 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5199
5200 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5201 bar->prev = Qnil;
5202 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5203 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5204 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5205 }
5206
5207 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5208 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5209
5210 static void
5211 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5212 FRAME_PTR f;
5213 {
5214 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5215
5216 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5217
5218 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5219 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5220 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5221
5222 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5223 {
5224 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5225
5226 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5227
5228 next = b->next;
5229 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5233 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5234 }
5235
5236
5237 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5238 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5239 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5240
5241 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5242 mark bits. */
5243
5244 static void
5245 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5246 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5247 XEvent *event;
5248 {
5249 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5250 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5251 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5252 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5253
5254 BLOCK_INPUT;
5255
5256 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5257
5258 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5259 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5260
5261 /* x, y, width, height */
5262 0, 0,
5263 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5264 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5265
5266 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5267
5268 }
5269 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5270
5271 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5272 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5273
5274 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5275 mark bits. */
5276
5277
5278 static void
5279 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5280 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5281 XEvent *event;
5282 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5283 {
5284 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5285 abort ();
5286
5287 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5288 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5289 emacs_event->modifiers
5290 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5291 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5292 event->xbutton.state)
5293 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5294 ? up_modifier
5295 : down_modifier));
5296 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5297 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5298 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5299 {
5300 #if 0
5301 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5302 int internal_height
5303 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5304 #endif
5305 int top_range
5306 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5307 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5308
5309 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5310 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5311
5312 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5313 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5314 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5315 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5316 else
5317 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5318
5319 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5320 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5321 whether or not we're dragging. */
5322 #if 0
5323 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5324 holding it. */
5325 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5326 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5327 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5328 #endif
5329
5330 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5331 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5332 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5333 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5334 {
5335 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5336 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5337
5338 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5339 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5340 }
5341 #endif
5342
5343 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5344 #if 0
5345 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5346 the handle. */
5347 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5348 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5349 else
5350 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5351 #else
5352 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5353 #endif
5354
5355 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5356 }
5357 }
5358
5359 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5360
5361 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5362
5363 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5364 mark bits. */
5365
5366 static void
5367 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5368 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5369 XEvent *event;
5370 {
5371 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5372
5373 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5374
5375 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5376 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5377
5378 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5379 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5380 {
5381 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5382 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5383
5384 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5385 {
5386 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5387
5388 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5389 }
5390 }
5391 }
5392
5393 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5394
5395 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5396 on the scroll bar. */
5397
5398 static void
5399 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5400 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5401 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5402 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5403 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5404 unsigned long *time;
5405 {
5406 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5407 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5408 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5409 int win_x, win_y;
5410 Window dummy_window;
5411 int dummy_coord;
5412 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5413
5414 BLOCK_INPUT;
5415
5416 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5417 report that. */
5418 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5419
5420 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5421 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5422 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5423
5424 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5425 &win_x, &win_y,
5426
5427 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5428 &dummy_mask))
5429 ;
5430 else
5431 {
5432 #if 0
5433 int inside_height
5434 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5435 #endif
5436 int top_range
5437 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5438
5439 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5440
5441 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5442 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5443
5444 if (win_y < 0)
5445 win_y = 0;
5446 if (win_y > top_range)
5447 win_y = top_range;
5448
5449 *fp = f;
5450 *bar_window = bar->window;
5451
5452 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5453 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5454 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5455 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5456 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5457 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5458 else
5459 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5460
5461 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5462 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5463
5464 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5465 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5466 }
5467
5468 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5469
5470 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5471 }
5472
5473
5474 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5475 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5476 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5477 redraw them. */
5478
5479 void
5480 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5481 FRAME_PTR f;
5482 {
5483 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5484 Lisp_Object bar;
5485
5486 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5487 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5488 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5489 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5490 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5491 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5492 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5493 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5494 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5495 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5496 }
5497
5498 \f
5499 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5500
5501 #if 0
5502 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5503 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5504 sometimes don't work. */
5505
5506 static Time enter_timestamp;
5507 #endif
5508
5509 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5510 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5511 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5512 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5513
5514 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5515 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5516
5517 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5518
5519 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5520 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5521
5522 static int temp_index;
5523 static short temp_buffer[100];
5524
5525 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5526 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5527 temp_index = 0; \
5528 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5529
5530 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5531 on a particular display. */
5532
5533 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5534
5535 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5536 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5537 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5538 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5539
5540 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5541
5542 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5543 do \
5544 { \
5545 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5546 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5547 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5548 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5549 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5550 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5551 } \
5552 while (0)
5553
5554 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5555 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5556
5557
5558 enum
5559 {
5560 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5561 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5562 X_EVENT_DROP
5563 };
5564
5565 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5566 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5567 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5568
5569 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5570 this event further.
5571 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5572
5573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5574 static int
5575 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5576 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5577 XEvent *event;
5578 {
5579 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5580 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5581 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5582 was created. */
5583
5584 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5585 event->xclient.window);
5586
5587 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5588 }
5589 #endif
5590
5591 #ifdef USE_GTK
5592 static int current_count;
5593 static int current_finish;
5594 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5595
5596 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5597 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5598 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5599 static GdkFilterReturn
5600 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5601 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5602 GdkEvent *ev;
5603 gpointer data;
5604 {
5605 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5606
5607 if (current_count >= 0)
5608 {
5609 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5610
5611 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5612
5613 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5614 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5615 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5616 so we do it here. */
5617 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5618 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5619 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5620 #endif
5621
5622 if (! dpyinfo)
5623 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5624 else
5625 {
5626 current_count +=
5627 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5628 current_hold_quit);
5629 }
5630 }
5631 else
5632 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5633
5634 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5635 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5636
5637 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5638 }
5639 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5640
5641
5642 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5643
5644 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5645 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5646 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5647
5648 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5649
5650 static int
5651 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5652 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5653 XEvent *eventp;
5654 int *finish;
5655 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5656 {
5657 union {
5658 struct input_event ie;
5659 struct selection_input_event sie;
5660 } inev;
5661 int count = 0;
5662 int do_help = 0;
5663 int nbytes = 0;
5664 struct frame *f;
5665 struct coding_system coding;
5666 XEvent event = *eventp;
5667
5668 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5669
5670 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5671 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5672 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5673
5674 switch (event.type)
5675 {
5676 case ClientMessage:
5677 {
5678 if (event.xclient.message_type
5679 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5680 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5681 {
5682 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5683 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5684 {
5685 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5686 could be the shell widget window
5687 if the frame has no title bar. */
5688 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5689 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5690 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5691 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5692 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5693 #endif
5694 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5695 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5696 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5697 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5698 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5699 needed.
5700
5701 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5702 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5703 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5704 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5705 Emacs. */
5706
5707 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5708 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5709 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5710 if (f)
5711 {
5712 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5713 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5714 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5715 x_catch_errors (d);
5716 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5717 /* The ICCCM says this is
5718 the only valid choice. */
5719 RevertToParent,
5720 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5721 /* This is needed to detect the error
5722 if there is an error. */
5723 XSync (d, False);
5724 x_uncatch_errors ();
5725 }
5726 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5727 #endif /* 0 */
5728 goto done;
5729 }
5730
5731 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5732 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5733 {
5734 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5735 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5736 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5737 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5738 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5739 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5740 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5741 session manager and one for this. */
5742 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5743 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5744 #endif
5745 {
5746 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5747 event.xclient.window);
5748 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5749 for a single Emacs process. */
5750 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5751 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5752 event.xclient.window,
5753 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5754 else if (f)
5755 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5756 event.xclient.window,
5757 0, 0);
5758 }
5759 goto done;
5760 }
5761
5762 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5763 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5764 {
5765 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5766 event.xclient.window);
5767 if (!f)
5768 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5769
5770 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5771 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5772 goto done;
5773 }
5774
5775 goto done;
5776 }
5777
5778 if (event.xclient.message_type
5779 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5780 {
5781 goto done;
5782 }
5783
5784 if (event.xclient.message_type
5785 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5786 {
5787 int new_x, new_y;
5788 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5789
5790 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5791 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5792
5793 if (f)
5794 {
5795 f->left_pos = new_x;
5796 f->top_pos = new_y;
5797 }
5798 goto done;
5799 }
5800
5801 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5802 if (event.xclient.message_type
5803 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5804 {
5805 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5806 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5807 &event, NULL);
5808 goto done;
5809 }
5810 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5811
5812 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5813 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5814 || (event.xclient.message_type
5815 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5816 {
5817 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5818 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5819 currently never do because we are interested in
5820 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5821 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5822 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5823 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5824 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5825 goto done;
5826 }
5827
5828 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5829 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5830 we construct an input_event. */
5831 if (event.xclient.message_type
5832 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5833 {
5834 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5835 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5836 goto done;
5837 }
5838 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5839
5840 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5841
5842 if (!f)
5843 goto OTHER;
5844
5845 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5846 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5847 }
5848 break;
5849
5850 case SelectionNotify:
5851 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5852 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5853 goto OTHER;
5854 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5855 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5856 break;
5857
5858 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5859 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5860 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5861 goto OTHER;
5862 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5863 {
5864 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5865
5866 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5867 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5868 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5869 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5870 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5871 }
5872 break;
5873
5874 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5875 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5876 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5877 goto OTHER;
5878 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5879 {
5880 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5881 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5882
5883 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5884 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5886 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5887 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5888 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5889 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5890 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5891 }
5892 break;
5893
5894 case PropertyNotify:
5895 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5896 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5897 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5898 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5899 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5900 goto OTHER;
5901 #endif
5902 #endif
5903 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5904 goto OTHER;
5905
5906 case ReparentNotify:
5907 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5908 if (f)
5909 {
5910 int x, y;
5911 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5912 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5913 f->left_pos = x;
5914 f->top_pos = y;
5915
5916 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5917 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5918 }
5919 goto OTHER;
5920
5921 case Expose:
5922 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5923 if (f)
5924 {
5925 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5926
5927 #ifdef USE_GTK
5928 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5929 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5930 event.xexpose.window,
5931 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5932 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5933 FALSE);
5934 #endif
5935 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5936 {
5937 f->async_visible = 1;
5938 f->async_iconified = 0;
5939 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5940 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5941 }
5942 else
5943 expose_frame (f,
5944 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5945 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5946 }
5947 else
5948 {
5949 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5950 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5951 #endif
5952 #if defined USE_LUCID
5953 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5954 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5955 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5956 {
5957 Widget widget
5958 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5959 if (widget)
5960 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5961 }
5962 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5963
5964 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5965 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5966 goto OTHER;
5967 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5968 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5969 event.xexpose.window);
5970
5971 if (bar)
5972 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5973 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5974 else
5975 goto OTHER;
5976 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5977 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5978 }
5979 break;
5980
5981 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5982 source area was obscured or not
5983 available. */
5984 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5985 if (f)
5986 {
5987 expose_frame (f,
5988 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
5989 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
5990 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
5991 }
5992 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5993 else
5994 goto OTHER;
5995 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5996 break;
5997
5998 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5999 source area was completely
6000 available. */
6001 break;
6002
6003 case UnmapNotify:
6004 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6005 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6006 {
6007 tip_window = 0;
6008 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6009 }
6010
6011 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6012 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6013 the frame was deleted. */
6014 {
6015 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6016 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6017 display that won't ever be seen. */
6018 f->async_visible = 0;
6019 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6020 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6021 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6022 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6023 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6024 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6025 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6026 {
6027 f->async_iconified = 1;
6028
6029 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6030 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6031 }
6032 }
6033 goto OTHER;
6034
6035 case MapNotify:
6036 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6037 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6038 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6039 goto OTHER;
6040
6041 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6042 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6043 frame is visible. */
6044 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6045 if (f)
6046 {
6047 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6048 the frame's display structures.
6049 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6050 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6051 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6052 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6053 if (! f->async_iconified)
6054 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6055
6056 f->async_visible = 1;
6057 f->async_iconified = 0;
6058 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6059
6060 if (f->iconified)
6061 {
6062 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6063 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6064 }
6065 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6066 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6067 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6068 to update the frame titles
6069 in case this is the second frame. */
6070 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6071 }
6072 goto OTHER;
6073
6074 case KeyPress:
6075
6076 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6077
6078 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6079 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6080 if (popup_activated ())
6081 goto OTHER;
6082 #endif
6083
6084 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6085
6086 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6087 && !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
6088 {
6089 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6090 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6091 }
6092
6093 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6094 if (f == 0)
6095 {
6096 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6097 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6098 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6099 event.xkey.window);
6100 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6101 {
6102 widget = XtParent (widget);
6103 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6104 }
6105 }
6106 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6107
6108 if (f != 0)
6109 {
6110 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6111 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6112 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6113 his Emacs hang.
6114
6115 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6116 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6117 status_return even if the input is too long to
6118 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6119 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6120 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6121 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6122 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6123 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6124 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6125 int modifiers;
6126 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6127 Lisp_Object c;
6128
6129 #ifdef USE_GTK
6130 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6131 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6132 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6133 (see above). */
6134 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6135 #endif
6136
6137 event.xkey.state
6138 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6139 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6140 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6141
6142 /* This will have to go some day... */
6143
6144 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6145 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6146 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6147 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6148 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6149 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6150 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6151
6152 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6153 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6154 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6155 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6156 not it is combined with Meta. */
6157 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6158 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6159
6160 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6161 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6162 {
6163 Status status_return;
6164
6165 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6166 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6167 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6168 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6169 &status_return);
6170 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6171 {
6172 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6173 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6174 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6175 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6176 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6177 &status_return);
6178 }
6179 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6180 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6181 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6182 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6183 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6184 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6185 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6186 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6187 &status_return);
6188 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6189 {
6190 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6191 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6192 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6193 &event.xkey,
6194 copy_bufptr,
6195 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6196 &status_return);
6197 }
6198 }
6199 #endif
6200
6201 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6202 break;
6203 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6204 {
6205 keysym = NoSymbol;
6206 modifiers = 0;
6207 }
6208 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6209 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6210 abort ();
6211 }
6212 else
6213 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6214 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6215 &compose_status);
6216 #else
6217 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6218 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6219 &compose_status);
6220 #endif
6221
6222 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6223 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6224 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6225 break;
6226
6227 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6228 orig_keysym = keysym;
6229
6230 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6231 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6232 inev.ie.modifiers
6233 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6234 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6235
6236 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6237 translations to characters. */
6238 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6239 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6240 {
6241 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6242 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6243 goto done_keysym;
6244 }
6245
6246 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6247 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6248 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6249 {
6250 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6251
6252 if (code < 0x80)
6253 {
6254 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6255 inev.ie.code = code;
6256 }
6257 else if (code < 0x100)
6258 {
6259 if (code < 0xA0)
6260 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6261 else
6262 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6263 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6264 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6265 }
6266 else
6267 {
6268 if (code < 0x2500)
6269 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6270 code -= 0x100;
6271 else if (code < 0xE000)
6272 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6273 code -= 0x2500;
6274 else
6275 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6276 code -= 0xE000;
6277 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6278 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6279 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6280 }
6281 goto done_keysym;
6282 }
6283
6284 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6285 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6286 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6287 Vx_keysym_table,
6288 Qnil))))
6289 {
6290 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6291 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6292 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6293 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6294 goto done_keysym;
6295 }
6296
6297 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6298 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6299 || keysym == XK_Delete
6300 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6301 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6302 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6303 #endif
6304 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6305 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6306 #ifdef HPUX
6307 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6308 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6309 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6310 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6311 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6312 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6313 #endif
6314 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6315 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6316 #endif
6317 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6318 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6319 #endif
6320 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6321 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6322 #endif
6323 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6324 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6325 #endif
6326 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6327 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6328 #endif
6329 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6330 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6331 #endif
6332 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6333 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6334 #endif
6335 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6336 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6337 #endif
6338 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6339 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6340 #endif
6341 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6342 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6343 #endif
6344 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6345 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6346 #endif
6347 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6348 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6349 #endif
6350 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6351 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6352 #endif
6353 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6354 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6355 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6356 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6357 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6358 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6359 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6360 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6361 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6364 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6365 #endif
6366 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6367 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6368 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6369 don't have real modifiers but
6370 should be treated similarly to
6371 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6372 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6373 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6374 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6375 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6376 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6377 #endif
6378 ))
6379 {
6380 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6381 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6382 key. */
6383 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6384 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6385 goto done_keysym;
6386 }
6387
6388 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6389 register int i;
6390 register int c;
6391 int nchars, len;
6392
6393 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6394 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6395 we used just above and the locale. */
6396 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6397 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6398 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6399 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6400 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6401 gives us composition information. */
6402 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6403
6404 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6405 {
6406 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6407 }
6408
6409 {
6410 /* Decode the input data. */
6411 int require;
6412 unsigned char *p;
6413
6414 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6415 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6416 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6417 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6418 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6419 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6420 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6421 nbytes = coding.produced;
6422 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6423 copy_bufptr = p;
6424 }
6425
6426 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6427 character events. */
6428 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6429 {
6430 if (nchars == nbytes)
6431 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6432 else
6433 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6434 nbytes - i, len);
6435 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6436 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6437 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6438 inev.ie.code = c;
6439 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6440 }
6441
6442 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6443 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6444 count += nbytes;
6445
6446 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6447
6448 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6449 break;
6450 }
6451 }
6452 done_keysym:
6453 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6454 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6455 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6456 client. */
6457 break;
6458 #else
6459 goto OTHER;
6460 #endif
6461
6462 case KeyRelease:
6463 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6464 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6465 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6466 client. */
6467 break;
6468 #else
6469 goto OTHER;
6470 #endif
6471
6472 case EnterNotify:
6473 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6474
6475 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6476
6477 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6478 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6479
6480 #if 0
6481 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6482 {
6483 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6484 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6485 || !(f->auto_lower)
6486 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6487 {
6488 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6489 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6490 }
6491 }
6492 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6493 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6494 #endif
6495
6496 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6497 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6498 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6499 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6500 #ifdef USE_GTK
6501 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6502 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6503 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6504 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6505 #endif
6506 goto OTHER;
6507
6508 case FocusIn:
6509 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6510 goto OTHER;
6511
6512 case LeaveNotify:
6513 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6514
6515 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6516 if (f)
6517 {
6518 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6519 {
6520 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6521 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6522 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6523 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6524 }
6525
6526 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6527 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6528 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6529 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6530 if (any_help_event_p)
6531 do_help = -1;
6532 }
6533 #ifdef USE_GTK
6534 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6535 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6536 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6537 #endif
6538 goto OTHER;
6539
6540 case FocusOut:
6541 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6542 goto OTHER;
6543
6544 case MotionNotify:
6545 {
6546 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6547 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6548
6549 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6550 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6551 f = last_mouse_frame;
6552 else
6553 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6554
6555 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6556 {
6557 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6558 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6559 }
6560
6561 if (f)
6562 {
6563
6564 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6565 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6566 {
6567 Lisp_Object window;
6568
6569 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6570 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6571 0, 0, 0, 0);
6572
6573 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6574 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6575 will be selected iff it is active. */
6576 if (WINDOWP (window)
6577 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6578 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6579 {
6580 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6581 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6582 }
6583
6584 last_window=window;
6585 }
6586 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6587 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6588 }
6589 else
6590 {
6591 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6592 struct scroll_bar *bar
6593 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6594 event.xmotion.window);
6595
6596 if (bar)
6597 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6598 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6599
6600 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6601 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6602 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6603 }
6604
6605 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6606 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6607 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6608 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6609 do_help = 1;
6610 goto OTHER;
6611 }
6612
6613 case ConfigureNotify:
6614 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6615 if (f)
6616 {
6617 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6618 #ifdef USE_GTK
6619 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6620 event.xconfigure.height);
6621 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6622 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6623 do this one, the right one will come later.
6624 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6625 need to reset it below. */
6626 int dont_resize
6627 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6628 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6629 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6630 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6631
6632 if (dont_resize)
6633 goto OTHER;
6634
6635 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6636 is called by the code that handles resizing
6637 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6638
6639 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6640 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6641 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6642 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6643 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6644 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6645 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6646 {
6647 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6648 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6649 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6650 }
6651 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6652 #endif
6653
6654 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6655 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6656
6657 #ifdef USE_GTK
6658 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6659 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6660 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6661 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6662 #endif
6663 {
6664 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6665 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6666 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6667
6668 x_check_expected_move (f);
6669 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6670 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6671 }
6672
6673 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6674 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6675 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6676 #endif
6677
6678 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6679 {
6680 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6681 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6682 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6683 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6684 }
6685 }
6686 goto OTHER;
6687
6688 case ButtonRelease:
6689 case ButtonPress:
6690 {
6691 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6692 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6693 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6694
6695 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6696 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6697
6698 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6699 && last_mouse_frame
6700 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6701 f = last_mouse_frame;
6702 else
6703 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6704
6705 if (f)
6706 {
6707 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6708 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6709 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6710 {
6711 Lisp_Object window;
6712 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6713 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6714
6715 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6716 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6717 {
6718 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6719 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6720 else
6721 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6722 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6723 event.xbutton.state));
6724 tool_bar_p = 1;
6725 }
6726 }
6727
6728 if (!tool_bar_p)
6729 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6730 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6731 {
6732 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6733 if (! popup_activated ())
6734 #endif
6735 {
6736 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6737 {
6738 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6739 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6740 {
6741 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6742 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6743 }
6744 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6745 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6746 }
6747 else
6748 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6749 }
6750 }
6751 }
6752 else
6753 {
6754 struct scroll_bar *bar
6755 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6756 event.xbutton.window);
6757
6758 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6759 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6760 scroll bars. */
6761 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6762 {
6763 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6764 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6765 }
6766 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6767 if (bar)
6768 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6769 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6770 }
6771
6772 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6773 {
6774 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6775 last_mouse_frame = f;
6776
6777 if (!tool_bar_p)
6778 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6779 }
6780 else
6781 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6782
6783 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6784 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6785 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6786 if (f != 0)
6787 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6788
6789 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6790 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6791 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6792 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6793 Instead, save it away
6794 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6795 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6796 if (
6797 #ifdef USE_GTK
6798 ! popup_activated ()
6799 &&
6800 #endif
6801 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6802 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6803 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6804 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6805 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6806 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6807 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6808 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6809 {
6810 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6811 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6812 #ifdef USE_GTK
6813 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6814 #endif
6815 }
6816 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6817 {
6818 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6819 goto OTHER;
6820 }
6821
6822 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6823 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6824 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6825 {
6826 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6827 {
6828 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6829 if (f->output_data.x)
6830 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6831 }
6832 else
6833 goto OTHER;
6834 }
6835 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6836 else
6837 goto OTHER;
6838 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6839 }
6840 break;
6841
6842 case CirculateNotify:
6843 goto OTHER;
6844
6845 case CirculateRequest:
6846 goto OTHER;
6847
6848 case VisibilityNotify:
6849 goto OTHER;
6850
6851 case MappingNotify:
6852 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6853 local cache. */
6854 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6855 {
6856 case MappingModifier:
6857 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6858 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6859 case MappingKeyboard:
6860 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6861 }
6862 goto OTHER;
6863
6864 default:
6865 OTHER:
6866 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6867 BLOCK_INPUT;
6868 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6869 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6870 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6871 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6872 break;
6873 }
6874
6875 done:
6876 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6877 {
6878 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6879 count++;
6880 }
6881
6882 if (do_help
6883 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6884 {
6885 Lisp_Object frame;
6886
6887 if (f)
6888 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6889 else
6890 frame = Qnil;
6891
6892 if (do_help > 0)
6893 {
6894 any_help_event_p = 1;
6895 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6896 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6897 }
6898 else
6899 {
6900 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6901 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6902 }
6903 count++;
6904 }
6905
6906 *eventp = event;
6907 return count;
6908 }
6909
6910
6911 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6912 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6913 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6914
6915 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6916 int
6917 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6918 XEvent *event;
6919 Display *display;
6920 {
6921 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6922 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6923
6924 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6925
6926 if (dpyinfo)
6927 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6928
6929 return finish;
6930 }
6931
6932
6933 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6934 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6935 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6936
6937 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6938 thus pretending to be `read'.
6939
6940 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6941
6942 static int
6943 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6944 register int sd;
6945 int expected;
6946 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6947 {
6948 int count = 0;
6949 XEvent event;
6950 int event_found = 0;
6951 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6952
6953 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6954 {
6955 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6956 return -1;
6957 }
6958
6959 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6960 BLOCK_INPUT;
6961
6962 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6963 input_signal_count++;
6964
6965 ++handling_signal;
6966
6967 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6968 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6969 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6970 {
6971 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6972 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6973 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6974 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6975 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6976 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6977 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6978 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6979 #endif
6980
6981 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6982 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6983 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6984 for X connections. */
6985 #ifndef SIGIO
6986 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
6987 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
6988 {
6989 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
6990 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
6991 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6992 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
6993 }
6994 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
6995 #endif /* SIGIO */
6996 #endif
6997
6998 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6999 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7000 {
7001 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7002 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7003 }
7004
7005 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7006 {
7007 struct input_event inev;
7008 BLOCK_INPUT;
7009 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7010 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7011 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7012 {
7013 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7014 count++;
7015 }
7016 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7017 }
7018 #endif
7019
7020 #ifndef USE_GTK
7021 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7022 {
7023 int finish;
7024
7025 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7026
7027 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7028 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7029 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7030 break;
7031 #endif
7032 event_found = 1;
7033
7034 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7035
7036 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7037 goto out;
7038 }
7039 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7040 }
7041
7042 #ifdef USE_GTK
7043
7044 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7045 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7046 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7047 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7048
7049 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7050 from all displays. */
7051
7052 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7053 {
7054 current_count = count;
7055 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7056
7057 gtk_main_iteration ();
7058
7059 count = current_count;
7060 current_count = -1;
7061 current_hold_quit = 0;
7062
7063 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7064 break;
7065 }
7066 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7067
7068 out:;
7069
7070 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7071 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7072 if (! event_found)
7073 {
7074 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7075 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7076 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7077 x_noop_count++;
7078 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7079 {
7080 x_noop_count=0;
7081
7082 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7083 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7084
7085 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7086
7087 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7088 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7089 }
7090 }
7091
7092 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7093 raise it now. */
7094 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7095 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7096 {
7097 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7098 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7099 }
7100
7101 --handling_signal;
7102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7103
7104 return count;
7105 }
7106
7107
7108
7109 \f
7110 /***********************************************************************
7111 Text Cursor
7112 ***********************************************************************/
7113
7114 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7115 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7116
7117 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7118 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7119 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7120
7121 static void
7122 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7123 struct window *w;
7124 struct glyph_row *row;
7125 int area;
7126 GC gc;
7127 {
7128 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7129 XRectangle clip_rect;
7130 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7131
7132 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7133
7134 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7135 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7136 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7137 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7138 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7139
7140 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7141 }
7142
7143
7144 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7145
7146 static void
7147 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7148 struct window *w;
7149 struct glyph_row *row;
7150 {
7151 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7152 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7153 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7154 int x, y, wd, h;
7155 XGCValues xgcv;
7156 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7157 GC gc;
7158
7159 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7160 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7161 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7162 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7163 return;
7164
7165 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7166 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7167 y = get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &h);
7168 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7169
7170 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7171 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7172 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7173 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7174 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7175 else
7176 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7177 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7178 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7179
7180 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7181 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7182 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7183 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7184 }
7185
7186
7187 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7188
7189 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7190 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7191 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7192 --gerd. */
7193
7194 static void
7195 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7196 struct window *w;
7197 struct glyph_row *row;
7198 int width;
7199 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7200 {
7201 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7202 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7203
7204 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7205 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7206 and mini-buffer. */
7207 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7208 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7209 return;
7210
7211 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7212 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7213 the bar might not be in the window. */
7214 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7215 {
7216 struct glyph_row *row;
7217 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7218 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7219 }
7220 else
7221 {
7222 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7223 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7224 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7225 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7226 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7227 XGCValues xgcv;
7228
7229 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7230 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7231 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7232 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7233 that the glyph is legible. */
7234 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7235 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7236 else
7237 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7238 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7239
7240 if (gc)
7241 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7242 else
7243 {
7244 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7245 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7246 }
7247
7248 if (width < 0)
7249 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7250 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7251
7252 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7253 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7254
7255 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7256 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7257 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7258 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7259 width, row->height);
7260 else
7261 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7262 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7263 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7264 row->height - width),
7265 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7266 width);
7267
7268 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7269 }
7270 }
7271
7272
7273 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7274
7275 static void
7276 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7277 struct frame *f;
7278 Cursor cursor;
7279 {
7280 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7281 }
7282
7283
7284 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7285
7286 static void
7287 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7288 struct frame *f;
7289 int x, y, width, height;
7290 {
7291 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7292 x, y, width, height, False);
7293 }
7294
7295
7296 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7297
7298 static void
7299 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7300 struct window *w;
7301 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7302 int x, y;
7303 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7304 int on_p, active_p;
7305 {
7306 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7307
7308 if (on_p)
7309 {
7310 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7311 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7312
7313 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7314 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7315 {
7316 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7317 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7318 }
7319 else
7320 switch (cursor_type)
7321 {
7322 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7323 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7324 break;
7325
7326 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7327 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7328 break;
7329
7330 case BAR_CURSOR:
7331 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7332 break;
7333
7334 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7335 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7336 break;
7337
7338 case NO_CURSOR:
7339 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7340 break;
7341
7342 default:
7343 abort ();
7344 }
7345
7346 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7347 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7348 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7349 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7350 #endif
7351 }
7352
7353 #ifndef XFlush
7354 if (updating_frame != f)
7355 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7356 #endif
7357 }
7358
7359 \f
7360 /* Icons. */
7361
7362 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7363
7364 int
7365 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7366 struct frame *f;
7367 Lisp_Object file;
7368 {
7369 int bitmap_id;
7370
7371 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7372 return 1;
7373
7374 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7375 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7376 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7377 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7378
7379 if (STRINGP (file))
7380 {
7381 #ifdef USE_GTK
7382 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7383 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7384 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7385 return 0;
7386 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7387 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7388 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7389 }
7390 else
7391 {
7392 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7393 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7394 {
7395 int rc = -1;
7396
7397 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7398 #ifdef USE_GTK
7399 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7400 return 0;
7401 #else
7402 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7403 if (rc != -1)
7404 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7405 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7406 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7407
7408 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7409 if (rc == -1)
7410 {
7411 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7412 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7413 if (rc == -1)
7414 return 1;
7415
7416 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7417 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7418 }
7419 }
7420
7421 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7422 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7423 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7424 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7425 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7426
7427 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7428 }
7429
7430 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7431 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7432
7433 return 0;
7434 }
7435
7436
7437 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7438 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7439
7440 int
7441 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7442 struct frame *f;
7443 char *icon_name;
7444 {
7445 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7446 return 1;
7447
7448 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7449 {
7450 XTextProperty text;
7451 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7452 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7453 text.format = 8;
7454 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7455 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7456 }
7457 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7458 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7459 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7460
7461 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7462 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7463 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7464 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7465
7466 return 0;
7467 }
7468 \f
7469 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7470
7471 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7472 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7473
7474 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7475 be called from a signal handler.
7476 */
7477
7478 struct x_error_message_stack {
7479 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7480 Display *dpy;
7481 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7482 };
7483 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7484
7485 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7486 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7487 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7488
7489 static void
7490 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7491 Display *display;
7492 XErrorEvent *error;
7493 {
7494 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7495 x_error_message->string,
7496 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7497 }
7498
7499 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7500 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7501 operating on.
7502
7503 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7504 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7505 stored in x_error_message_string.
7506
7507 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7508 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7509
7510 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7511
7512 void x_check_errors ();
7513
7514 void
7515 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7516 Display *dpy;
7517 {
7518 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7519
7520 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7521 XSync (dpy, False);
7522
7523 data->dpy = dpy;
7524 data->string[0] = 0;
7525 data->prev = x_error_message;
7526 x_error_message = data;
7527 }
7528
7529 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7530 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7531
7532 void
7533 x_uncatch_errors ()
7534 {
7535 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7536
7537 BLOCK_INPUT;
7538
7539 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7540 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7541 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7542 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7543
7544 tmp = x_error_message;
7545 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7546 xfree (tmp);
7547 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7548 }
7549
7550 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7551 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7552 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7553
7554 void
7555 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7556 Display *dpy;
7557 char *format;
7558 {
7559 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7560 XSync (dpy, False);
7561
7562 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7563 {
7564 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7565 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7566 x_uncatch_errors ();
7567 error (format, string);
7568 }
7569 }
7570
7571 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7572 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7573
7574 int
7575 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7576 Display *dpy;
7577 {
7578 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7579 XSync (dpy, False);
7580
7581 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7582 }
7583
7584 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7585
7586 void
7587 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7588 Display *dpy;
7589 {
7590 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7591 }
7592
7593 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7594
7595 void
7596 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7597 {
7598 while (x_error_message)
7599 x_uncatch_errors ();
7600 }
7601
7602 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7603
7604 int
7605 x_catching_errors ()
7606 {
7607 return x_error_message != 0;
7608 }
7609
7610 #if 0
7611 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7612 x_trace_wire ()
7613 {
7614 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7615 }
7616 #endif /* ! 0 */
7617
7618 \f
7619 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7620 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7621 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7622 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7623 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7624
7625 static SIGTYPE
7626 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7627 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7628 {
7629 #ifdef USG
7630 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7631 must reestablish each time */
7632 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7633 #endif /* USG */
7634 }
7635
7636 \f
7637 /************************************************************************
7638 Handling X errors
7639 ************************************************************************/
7640
7641 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7642
7643 static char *error_msg;
7644
7645 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7646 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7647 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7648
7649 static void
7650 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7651 {
7652 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7653 exit (70);
7654 }
7655
7656 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7657 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7658
7659 static SIGTYPE
7660 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7661 Display *dpy;
7662 char *error_message;
7663 {
7664 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7665 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7666
7667 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7668 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7669 handling_signal = 0;
7670
7671 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7672 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7673 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7674 the original message here. */
7675 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7676
7677 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7678 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7679 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7680
7681 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7682 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7683 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7684
7685 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7686 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7687
7688 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7689 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7690 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7691
7692 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7693 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7694 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7695 if (dpyinfo)
7696 {
7697 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7698 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7699 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7700 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7701 }
7702 #endif
7703
7704 #ifdef USE_GTK
7705 if (dpyinfo)
7706 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7707 #endif
7708
7709 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7710 if (dpyinfo)
7711 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7712
7713 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7714 that are on the dead display. */
7715 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7716 {
7717 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7718 minibuf_frame
7719 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7720 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7721 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7722 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7723 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7724 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7725 }
7726
7727 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7728 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7729 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7730 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7731 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7732 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7733 {
7734 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7735 trying to find a replacement. */
7736 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7737 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7738 }
7739
7740 if (dpyinfo)
7741 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7742
7743 x_uncatch_errors ();
7744
7745 if (x_display_list == 0)
7746 {
7747 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7748 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7749 exit (70);
7750 }
7751
7752 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7753 #ifdef SIGIO
7754 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7755 #endif
7756 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7757 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7758
7759 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7760 error ("%s", error_msg);
7761 }
7762
7763 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7764 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7765 static void x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error);
7766
7767 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7768 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7769
7770 static int
7771 x_error_handler (display, error)
7772 Display *display;
7773 XErrorEvent *error;
7774 {
7775 if (x_error_message)
7776 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7777 else
7778 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7779 return 0;
7780 }
7781
7782 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7783 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7784 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7785
7786 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7787
7788 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7789 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7790 #else
7791 #define NO_INLINE
7792 #endif
7793
7794 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7795
7796 #ifdef noinline
7797 #undef noinline
7798 #endif
7799
7800 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7801 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7802
7803 static void NO_INLINE
7804 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7805 Display *display;
7806 XErrorEvent *error;
7807 {
7808 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7809
7810 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7811 original error handler. */
7812
7813 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7814 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7815 buf, error->request_code);
7816 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7817 }
7818
7819
7820 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7821 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7822 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7823
7824 static int
7825 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7826 Display *display;
7827 {
7828 char buf[256];
7829
7830 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7831 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7832 return 0;
7833 }
7834 \f
7835 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7836
7837 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7838 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7839 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7840 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7841
7842 Lisp_Object
7843 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7844 struct frame *f;
7845 register char *fontname;
7846 {
7847 struct font_info *fontp
7848 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7849
7850 if (!fontp)
7851 return Qnil;
7852
7853 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7854 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7855 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7856
7857 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7858 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7859 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7860
7861 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7862
7863 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7864 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7865 {
7866 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7867 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7868 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7869 }
7870 else
7871 {
7872 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7873 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7874 }
7875
7876 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7877 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7878 {
7879 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7880 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7881 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7882 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7883 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7884 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7885
7886 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7887 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7888 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7889 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7890 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7891 }
7892
7893 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7894 }
7895
7896 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7897 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7898 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7899 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7900
7901 Lisp_Object
7902 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7903 struct frame *f;
7904 char *fontsetname;
7905 {
7906 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7907 Lisp_Object result;
7908
7909 if (fontset < 0)
7910 return Qnil;
7911
7912 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7913 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7914 to do. */
7915 return fontset_name (fontset);
7916
7917 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7918
7919 if (!STRINGP (result))
7920 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7921 return Qnil;
7922
7923 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7924 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7925
7926 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7927 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7928 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7929 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7930 #endif
7931
7932 return build_string (fontsetname);
7933 }
7934
7935 \f
7936 /***********************************************************************
7937 X Input Methods
7938 ***********************************************************************/
7939
7940 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7941
7942 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7943
7944 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7945 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7946 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7947
7948 static void
7949 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7950 XIM xim;
7951 XPointer client_data;
7952 XPointer call_data;
7953 {
7954 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7955 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7956
7957 BLOCK_INPUT;
7958
7959 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7960 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7961 {
7962 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7963 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7964 {
7965 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7966 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7967 }
7968 }
7969
7970 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7971 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7972 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7973 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7974 }
7975
7976 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7977
7978 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7979 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7980 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7981 #endif
7982
7983 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7984 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7985
7986 static void
7987 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7988 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7989 char *resource_name;
7990 {
7991 XIM xim;
7992
7993 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7994 if (use_xim)
7995 {
7996 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7997 EMACS_CLASS);
7998 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7999
8000 if (xim)
8001 {
8002 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8003 XIMCallback destroy;
8004 #endif
8005
8006 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8007 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8008
8009 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8010 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8011 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8012 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8013 #endif
8014 }
8015 }
8016
8017 else
8018 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8019 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8020 }
8021
8022
8023 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8024
8025 struct xim_inst_t
8026 {
8027 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8028 char *resource_name;
8029 };
8030
8031 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8032 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8033 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8034 when the callback was registered. */
8035
8036 static void
8037 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8038 Display *display;
8039 XPointer client_data;
8040 XPointer call_data;
8041 {
8042 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8043 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8044
8045 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8046 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8047 return;
8048
8049 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8050
8051 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8052 as they have no XIC. */
8053 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8054 {
8055 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8056
8057 BLOCK_INPUT;
8058 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8059 {
8060 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8061
8062 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8063 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8064 {
8065 create_frame_xic (f);
8066 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8067 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8068 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8069 {
8070 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8071 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8072 }
8073 }
8074 }
8075
8076 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8077 }
8078 }
8079
8080 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8081
8082
8083 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8084 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8085 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8086 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8087
8088 static void
8089 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8090 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8091 char *resource_name;
8092 {
8093 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8094 if (use_xim)
8095 {
8096 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8097 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8098 int len;
8099
8100 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8101 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8102 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8103 len = strlen (resource_name);
8104 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8105 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8106 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8107 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8108 xim_instantiate_callback,
8109 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8110 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8111 least, hence the configure test. */
8112 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8113 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8114 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8115 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8116 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8117
8118 }
8119 else
8120 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8121 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8122 }
8123
8124
8125 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8126
8127 static void
8128 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8129 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8130 {
8131 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8132 if (use_xim)
8133 {
8134 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8135 if (dpyinfo->display)
8136 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8137 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8138 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8139 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8140 if (dpyinfo->display)
8141 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8142 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8143 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8144 }
8145 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8146 }
8147
8148 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8149
8150
8151 \f
8152 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8153 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8154
8155 void
8156 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8157 struct frame *f;
8158 {
8159 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8160
8161 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8162 is already for the top-left corner. */
8163 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8164 return;
8165
8166 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8167 position that fits on the screen. */
8168 if (flags & XNegative)
8169 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8170 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8171
8172 {
8173 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8174
8175 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8176 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8177 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8178
8179 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8180 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8181 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8182 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8183 is right, though.
8184
8185 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8186 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8187
8188 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8189 #endif
8190
8191 if (flags & YNegative)
8192 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8193 }
8194
8195 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8196 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8197 so the flags should correspond. */
8198 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8199 }
8200
8201 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8202 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8203 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8204 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8205 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8206
8207 void
8208 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8209 struct frame *f;
8210 register int xoff, yoff;
8211 int change_gravity;
8212 {
8213 int modified_top, modified_left;
8214
8215 if (change_gravity > 0)
8216 {
8217 f->top_pos = yoff;
8218 f->left_pos = xoff;
8219 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8220 if (xoff < 0)
8221 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8222 if (yoff < 0)
8223 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8224 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8225 }
8226 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8227
8228 BLOCK_INPUT;
8229 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8230
8231 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8232 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8233
8234 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8235 {
8236 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8237 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8238 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8239 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8240 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8241 }
8242
8243 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8244 modified_left, modified_top);
8245
8246 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8247 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8248 {
8249 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8250 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8251 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8252 }
8253
8254 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8255 }
8256
8257 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8258 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8259 static void
8260 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8261 struct frame *f;
8262 {
8263 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8264 {
8265 int width, height, ign;
8266
8267 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8268
8269 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8270
8271 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8272 when setting WM manager hints.
8273 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8274 x_check_expected_move. */
8275 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8276 {
8277 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8278 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8279 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8280
8281 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8282 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8283 }
8284 }
8285 }
8286
8287 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8288 the window.
8289 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8290 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8291 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8292 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8293 static void
8294 x_check_expected_move (f)
8295 struct frame *f;
8296 {
8297 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8298 {
8299 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8300 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8301
8302 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8303 {
8304 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8305 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8306 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8307
8308 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8309 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8310 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8311 }
8312 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8313 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8314
8315 /* Just do this once */
8316 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8317 }
8318 }
8319
8320
8321 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8322 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8323 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8324 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8325
8326 static void
8327 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8328 struct frame *f;
8329 int change_gravity;
8330 int cols, rows;
8331 {
8332 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8333
8334 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8335 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8336 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8337 ? 0
8338 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8339 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8340 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8341
8342 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8343
8344 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8345 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8346
8347 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8348 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8349
8350 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8351 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8352 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8353
8354 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8355 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8356 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8357 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8358
8359 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8360 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8361 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8362 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8363 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8364
8365 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8366 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8367 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8368 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8369 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8370
8371 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8372 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8373 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8374 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8375 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8376
8377 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8378 }
8379
8380
8381 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8382 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8383 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8384 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8385
8386 void
8387 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8388 struct frame *f;
8389 int change_gravity;
8390 int cols, rows;
8391 {
8392 BLOCK_INPUT;
8393
8394 #ifdef USE_GTK
8395 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8396 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8397 else
8398 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8399 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8400
8401 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8402 {
8403 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8404 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8405 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8406 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8407 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8408 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8409 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8410 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8411 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8412 }
8413 else
8414 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8415
8416 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8417
8418 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8419
8420 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8421
8422 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8423 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8424
8425 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8426 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8427 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8428 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8429 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8430
8431 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8432 }
8433 \f
8434 /* Mouse warping. */
8435
8436 void
8437 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8438 struct frame *f;
8439 int x, y;
8440 {
8441 int pix_x, pix_y;
8442
8443 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8444 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8445
8446 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8447 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8448
8449 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8450 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8451
8452 BLOCK_INPUT;
8453
8454 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8455 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8456 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8457 }
8458
8459 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8460
8461 void
8462 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8463 struct frame *f;
8464 int pix_x, pix_y;
8465 {
8466 BLOCK_INPUT;
8467
8468 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8469 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8470 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8471 }
8472 \f
8473 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8474
8475 void
8476 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8477 struct frame *f;
8478 {
8479 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8480 x_raise_frame (f);
8481 #endif
8482 #if 0
8483 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8484 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8485 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8486 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8487 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8488 #endif /* ! 0 */
8489 }
8490
8491 void
8492 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8493 struct frame *f;
8494 {
8495 #if 0
8496 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8497 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8498 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8499 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8500 #endif /* ! 0 */
8501 }
8502
8503 /* Raise frame F. */
8504
8505 void
8506 x_raise_frame (f)
8507 struct frame *f;
8508 {
8509 if (f->async_visible)
8510 {
8511 BLOCK_INPUT;
8512 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8513 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8515 }
8516 }
8517
8518 /* Lower frame F. */
8519
8520 void
8521 x_lower_frame (f)
8522 struct frame *f;
8523 {
8524 if (f->async_visible)
8525 {
8526 BLOCK_INPUT;
8527 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8528 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8529 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8530 }
8531 }
8532
8533 static void
8534 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8535 FRAME_PTR f;
8536 int raise_flag;
8537 {
8538 if (raise_flag)
8539 x_raise_frame (f);
8540 else
8541 x_lower_frame (f);
8542 }
8543 \f
8544 /* Change of visibility. */
8545
8546 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8547 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8548 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8549 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8550 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8551 finishes with it. */
8552
8553 void
8554 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8555 struct frame *f;
8556 {
8557 Lisp_Object type;
8558 int original_top, original_left;
8559 int retry_count = 2;
8560
8561 retry:
8562
8563 BLOCK_INPUT;
8564
8565 type = x_icon_type (f);
8566 if (!NILP (type))
8567 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8568
8569 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8570 {
8571 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8572 call x_set_offset a second time
8573 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8574 before the window gets really visible. */
8575 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8576 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8577 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8578
8579 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8580
8581 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8582 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8583 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8584 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8585 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8586 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8587 #ifdef USE_GTK
8588 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8589 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8590 #else
8591 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8592 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8593 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8594 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8595 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8596 to come back ok without this. */
8597 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8598 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8599 #endif
8600 }
8601
8602 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8603
8604 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8605 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8606 so that incoming events are handled. */
8607 {
8608 Lisp_Object frame;
8609 int count;
8610 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8611 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8612 will set it when they are handled. */
8613 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8614
8615 original_left = f->left_pos;
8616 original_top = f->top_pos;
8617
8618 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8620
8621 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8622
8623 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8624 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8625 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8626 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8627
8628 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8629 because the window manager may choose the position
8630 and we don't want to override it. */
8631
8632 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8633 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8634 && previously_visible)
8635 {
8636 Drawable rootw;
8637 int x, y;
8638 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8639
8640 BLOCK_INPUT;
8641
8642 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8643 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8644 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8645 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8646 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8647 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8648 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8649 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8650 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8651
8652 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8653 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8654 original_left, original_top);
8655
8656 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8657 }
8658
8659 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8660
8661 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8662 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8663 MapNotify at all.. */
8664 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8665 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8666 {
8667 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8668 x_sync (f);
8669
8670 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8671 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8672 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8673 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8674 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8675 probably a bug. */
8676 if (input_polling_used ())
8677 {
8678 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8679 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8680 handler reset it. */
8681 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8682 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8683 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8684 poll_for_input_1 ();
8685 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8686 }
8687
8688 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8689 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8690 }
8691
8692 /* 2000-09-28: In
8693
8694 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8695 (iconify-frame f)
8696 (raise-frame f))
8697
8698 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8699 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8700 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8701 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8702
8703 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8704 goto retry;
8705 }
8706 }
8707
8708 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8709
8710 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8711
8712 void
8713 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8714 struct frame *f;
8715 {
8716 Window window;
8717
8718 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8719 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8720
8721 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8722 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8723 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8724
8725 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8726 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8727 return;
8728 #endif
8729
8730 BLOCK_INPUT;
8731
8732 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8733 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8734 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8735 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8736 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8737 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8738
8739 #ifdef USE_GTK
8740 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8741 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8742 else
8743 #endif
8744 {
8745 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8746
8747 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8748 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8749 {
8750 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8751 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8752 }
8753 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8754
8755 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8756 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8757 {
8758 XEvent unmap;
8759
8760 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8761 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8762 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8763 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8764 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8765 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8766 False,
8767 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8768 &unmap))
8769 {
8770 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8771 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8772 }
8773 }
8774
8775 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8776 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8777 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8778 }
8779
8780 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8781 just by the event that we get from the server.
8782 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8783 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8784 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8785 f->visible = 0;
8786 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8787 f->async_visible = 0;
8788 f->async_iconified = 0;
8789
8790 x_sync (f);
8791
8792 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8793 }
8794
8795 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8796
8797 void
8798 x_iconify_frame (f)
8799 struct frame *f;
8800 {
8801 int result;
8802 Lisp_Object type;
8803
8804 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8805 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8806 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8807
8808 if (f->async_iconified)
8809 return;
8810
8811 BLOCK_INPUT;
8812
8813 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8814
8815 type = x_icon_type (f);
8816 if (!NILP (type))
8817 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8818
8819 #ifdef USE_GTK
8820 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8821 {
8822 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8823 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8824
8825 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8826 f->iconified = 1;
8827 f->visible = 1;
8828 f->async_iconified = 1;
8829 f->async_visible = 0;
8830 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8831 return;
8832 }
8833 #endif
8834
8835 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8836
8837 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8838 {
8839 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8840 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8841 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8842 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8843 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8844 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8845 so we have to record it here. */
8846 f->iconified = 1;
8847 f->visible = 1;
8848 f->async_iconified = 1;
8849 f->async_visible = 0;
8850 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8851 return;
8852 }
8853
8854 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8855 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8856 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8857 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8858
8859 if (!result)
8860 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8861
8862 f->async_iconified = 1;
8863 f->async_visible = 0;
8864
8865
8866 BLOCK_INPUT;
8867 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8868 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8869 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8870
8871 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8872 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8873 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8874 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8875
8876 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8877 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8878
8879 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8880 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8881 {
8882 XEvent message;
8883
8884 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8885 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8886 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8887 message.xclient.format = 32;
8888 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8889
8890 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8891 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8892 False,
8893 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8894 &message))
8895 {
8896 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8897 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8898 }
8899 }
8900
8901 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8902 IconicState. */
8903 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8904
8905 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8906 {
8907 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8908 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8909 }
8910
8911 f->async_iconified = 1;
8912 f->async_visible = 0;
8913
8914 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8915 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8916 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8917 }
8918
8919 \f
8920 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8921
8922 void
8923 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8924 struct frame *f;
8925 {
8926 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8927 Lisp_Object bar;
8928 struct scroll_bar *b;
8929
8930 BLOCK_INPUT;
8931
8932 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8933 commands to the X server. */
8934 if (dpyinfo->display)
8935 {
8936 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8937 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8938
8939 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8940 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8941 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8942 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8943 toolkit scroll bars. */
8944 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8945 {
8946 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8947 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8948 }
8949 #endif
8950
8951 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8952 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8953 free_frame_xic (f);
8954 #endif
8955
8956 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8957 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8958 {
8959 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8960 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8961 }
8962 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8963 we are using a toolkit. */
8964 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8965 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8966
8967 free_frame_menubar (f);
8968 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8969
8970 #ifdef USE_GTK
8971 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8972 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8973 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8974 {
8975 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8976 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8977 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8978 }
8979 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8980
8981 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8982 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8983 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8984
8985 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8986 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8987 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8988 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8989 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8990 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8991
8992 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8993 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8994 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8995 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8996 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8997 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8998 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8999 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9000 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9001 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9002 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9003 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9004 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9005 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9006 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9007
9008 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9009 free_frame_faces (f);
9010
9011 x_free_gcs (f);
9012 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9013 }
9014
9015 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9016 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9017
9018 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9019 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9020
9021 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9022 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9023 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9024 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9025 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9026 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9027
9028 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9029 {
9030 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9031 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9032 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9033 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9035 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9036 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9037 }
9038
9039 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9040 }
9041
9042
9043 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9044
9045 void
9046 x_destroy_window (f)
9047 struct frame *f;
9048 {
9049 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9050
9051 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9052 commands to the X server. */
9053 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9054 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9055
9056 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9057 }
9058
9059 \f
9060 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9061
9062 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9063 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9064 that the window now has.
9065 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9066 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9067 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9068
9069 #ifndef USE_GTK
9070 void
9071 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9072 struct frame *f;
9073 long flags;
9074 int user_position;
9075 {
9076 XSizeHints size_hints;
9077
9078 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9079 Arg al[2];
9080 int ac = 0;
9081 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9082 #endif
9083
9084 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9085
9086 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9087 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9088
9089 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9090 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9091
9092 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9093 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9094 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9095 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9096 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9097 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9098 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9099 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9100 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9101 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9102
9103 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9104 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9105 size_hints.max_width
9106 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9107 size_hints.max_height
9108 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9109
9110 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9111
9112 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9113 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9114 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9115 {
9116 int base_width, base_height;
9117 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9118
9119 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9120 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9121
9122 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9123
9124 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9125 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9126 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9127 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9128 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9129
9130 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9131 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9132 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9133
9134 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9135 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9136 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9137 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9138 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9139 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9140 #else
9141 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9142 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9143 #endif
9144 }
9145
9146 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9147 if (flags)
9148 {
9149 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9150 goto no_read;
9151 }
9152 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9153
9154 {
9155 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9156 long supplied_return;
9157 int value;
9158
9159 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9160 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9161 &supplied_return);
9162 #else
9163 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9164 #endif
9165
9166 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9167 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9168 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9169 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9170 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9171 #endif
9172
9173 if (flags)
9174 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9175 else
9176 {
9177 if (value == 0)
9178 hints.flags = 0;
9179 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9180 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9181 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9182 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9183 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9184 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9185 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9186 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9187 }
9188 }
9189
9190 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9191 no_read:
9192 #endif
9193
9194 #ifdef PWinGravity
9195 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9196 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9197
9198 if (user_position)
9199 {
9200 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9201 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9202 }
9203 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9204
9205 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9206 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9207 #else
9208 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9209 #endif
9210 }
9211 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9212
9213 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9214
9215 void
9216 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9217 struct frame *f;
9218 int state;
9219 {
9220 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9221 Arg al[1];
9222
9223 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9224 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9225 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9226 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9227
9228 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9229 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9230
9231 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9232 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9233 }
9234
9235 void
9236 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9237 struct frame *f;
9238 int pixmap_id;
9239 {
9240 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9241
9242 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9243 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9244 #endif
9245
9246 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9247 {
9248 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9249 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9250 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9251 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9252 }
9253 else
9254 {
9255 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9256 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9257 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9258 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9259 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9260 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9261 best to explicitly give up. */
9262 #if 0
9263 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9264 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9265 #else
9266 return;
9267 #endif
9268 }
9269
9270
9271 #ifdef USE_GTK
9272 {
9273 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9274 return;
9275 }
9276
9277 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9278
9279 {
9280 Arg al[1];
9281 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9282 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9283 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9284 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9285 }
9286
9287 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9288
9289 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9290 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9291
9292 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9293 }
9294
9295 void
9296 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9297 struct frame *f;
9298 int icon_x, icon_y;
9299 {
9300 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9301
9302 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9303 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9304 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9305
9306 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9307 }
9308
9309 \f
9310 /***********************************************************************
9311 Fonts
9312 ***********************************************************************/
9313
9314 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9315
9316 struct font_info *
9317 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9318 FRAME_PTR f;
9319 int font_idx;
9320 {
9321 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9322 }
9323
9324
9325 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9326
9327 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9328 to be listed.
9329
9330 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9331
9332 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9333 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9334 on how many fonts to match. */
9335
9336 Lisp_Object
9337 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9338 struct frame *f;
9339 Lisp_Object pattern;
9340 int size;
9341 int maxnames;
9342 {
9343 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9344 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9345 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9346 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9347 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9348 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9349 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9350
9351 if (size < 0)
9352 {
9353 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9354 size = 0;
9355 }
9356
9357 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9358 if (NILP (patterns))
9359 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9360
9361 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9362 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9363 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9364
9365 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9366 {
9367 int num_fonts;
9368 char **names = NULL;
9369
9370 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9371 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9372 The cache is an alist of the form:
9373 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9374 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9375 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9376 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9377 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9378 if (!NILP (list))
9379 {
9380 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9381 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9382 goto label_cached;
9383 }
9384
9385 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9386
9387 BLOCK_INPUT;
9388 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9389
9390 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9391 {
9392 XFontStruct *font;
9393 unsigned long value;
9394
9395 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9396 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9397 {
9398 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9399 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9400 font = NULL;
9401 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9402 }
9403
9404 if (font
9405 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9406 {
9407 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9408 int len = strlen (name);
9409 char *tmp;
9410
9411 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9412 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9413 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9414 if (len == 0)
9415 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9416 else
9417 {
9418 num_fonts = 1;
9419 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9420 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9421 simple var. */
9422 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9423 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9424 XFree (name);
9425 }
9426 }
9427 else
9428 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9429
9430 if (font)
9431 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9432 }
9433
9434 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9435 {
9436 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9437 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9438 if (maxnames < 0)
9439 {
9440 int limit;
9441
9442 for (limit = 500;;)
9443 {
9444 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9445 if (num_fonts == limit)
9446 {
9447 BLOCK_INPUT;
9448 XFreeFontNames (names);
9449 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9450 limit *= 2;
9451 }
9452 else
9453 break;
9454 }
9455 }
9456 else
9457 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9458 &num_fonts);
9459
9460 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9461 {
9462 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9463 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9464 names = NULL;
9465 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9466 }
9467 }
9468
9469 x_uncatch_errors ();
9470 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9471
9472 if (names)
9473 {
9474 int i;
9475
9476 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9477 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9478 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9479 {
9480 int width = 0;
9481 char *p = names[i];
9482 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9483
9484 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9485 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9486 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9487 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9488 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9489 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9490 while (*p)
9491 if (*p++ == '-')
9492 {
9493 dashes++;
9494 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9495 width = atoi (p);
9496 else if (dashes == 9)
9497 resx = atoi (p);
9498 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9499 average_width = atoi (p);
9500 }
9501
9502 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9503 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9504 {
9505 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9506 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9507 {
9508 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9509 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9510 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9511 >= 0))
9512 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9513 width of this font. */
9514 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9515 else
9516 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9517 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9518 }
9519 }
9520 }
9521
9522 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9523 {
9524 BLOCK_INPUT;
9525 XFreeFontNames (names);
9526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9527 }
9528 }
9529
9530 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9531 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9532 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9533
9534 label_cached:
9535 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9536
9537 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9538 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9539 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9540 {
9541 int found_size;
9542
9543 tem = XCAR (list);
9544
9545 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9546 continue;
9547 if (!size)
9548 {
9549 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9550 continue;
9551 }
9552
9553 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9554 {
9555 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9556 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9557 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9558
9559 BLOCK_INPUT;
9560 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9561 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9562 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9563 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9564 {
9565 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9566 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9567 thisinfo = NULL;
9568 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9569 }
9570 x_uncatch_errors ();
9571 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9572
9573 if (thisinfo)
9574 {
9575 XSETCDR (tem,
9576 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9577 ? make_number (0)
9578 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9579 BLOCK_INPUT;
9580 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9582 }
9583 else
9584 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9585 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9586 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9587 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9588 }
9589
9590 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9591 if (found_size == size)
9592 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9593 else if (found_size > 0)
9594 {
9595 if (NILP (second_best))
9596 second_best = tem;
9597 else if (found_size < size)
9598 {
9599 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9600 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9601 second_best = tem;
9602 }
9603 else
9604 {
9605 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9606 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9607 second_best = tem;
9608 }
9609 }
9610 }
9611 if (!NILP (newlist))
9612 break;
9613 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9614 {
9615 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9616 break;
9617 }
9618 }
9619
9620 return newlist;
9621 }
9622
9623
9624 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9625
9626 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9627 font table. */
9628
9629 static void
9630 x_check_font (f, font)
9631 struct frame *f;
9632 XFontStruct *font;
9633 {
9634 int i;
9635 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9636
9637 xassert (font != NULL);
9638
9639 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9640 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9641 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9642 break;
9643
9644 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9645 }
9646
9647 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9648
9649 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9650 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9651 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9652 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9653 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9654
9655 static INLINE void
9656 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9657 XFontStruct *font;
9658 int *w, *h;
9659 {
9660 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9661 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9662
9663 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9664 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9665 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9666 if (*w <= 0)
9667 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9668 }
9669
9670
9671 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9672 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9673 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9674 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9675 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9676
9677 static int
9678 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9679 struct frame *f;
9680 {
9681 int i;
9682 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9683 XFontStruct *font;
9684 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9685 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9686
9687 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9688 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9689
9690 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9691 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9692 {
9693 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9694 int w, h;
9695
9696 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9697 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9698 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9699
9700 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9701 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9702 }
9703
9704 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9705 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9706
9707 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9708 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9709 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9710 }
9711
9712
9713 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9714 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9715 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9716 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9717
9718 struct font_info *
9719 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9720 struct frame *f;
9721 register char *fontname;
9722 int size;
9723 {
9724 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9725 Lisp_Object font_names;
9726
9727 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9728 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9729 we already have by comparing names. */
9730 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9731
9732 if (!NILP (font_names))
9733 {
9734 Lisp_Object tail;
9735 int i;
9736
9737 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9738 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9739 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9740 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9741 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9742 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9743 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9744 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9745 }
9746
9747 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9748 {
9749 char *full_name;
9750 XFontStruct *font;
9751 struct font_info *fontp;
9752 unsigned long value;
9753 int i;
9754
9755 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9756 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9757 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9758 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9759 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9760 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9761 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9762
9763 BLOCK_INPUT;
9764 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9765 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9766 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9767 {
9768 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9769 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9770 font = NULL;
9771 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9772 }
9773 x_uncatch_errors ();
9774 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9775 if (!font)
9776 return NULL;
9777
9778 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9779 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9780 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9781 break;
9782
9783 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9784 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9785 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9786 {
9787 int sz;
9788 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9789 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9790 dpyinfo->font_table
9791 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9792 }
9793
9794 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9795 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9796 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9797
9798 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9799 BLOCK_INPUT;
9800 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9801 fontp->font = font;
9802 fontp->font_idx = i;
9803 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9804 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9805
9806 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9807 {
9808 /* Fixed width font. */
9809 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9810 }
9811 else
9812 {
9813 XChar2b char2b;
9814 XCharStruct *pcm;
9815
9816 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9817 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9818 if (pcm)
9819 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9820 else
9821 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9822
9823 fontp->average_width
9824 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9825 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9826 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9827 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9828 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9829 {
9830 if (pcm)
9831 {
9832 int width = pcm->width;
9833 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9834 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9835 width += pcm->width;
9836 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9837 }
9838 else
9839 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9840 }
9841 }
9842
9843 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9844 full_name = 0;
9845 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9846 {
9847 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9848 char *p = name;
9849 int dashes = 0;
9850
9851 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9852 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9853 so don't use it.
9854 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9855 stored in them. */
9856 while (*p)
9857 {
9858 if (*p == '-')
9859 dashes++;
9860 p++;
9861 }
9862
9863 if (dashes >= 13)
9864 {
9865 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9866 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9867 }
9868
9869 XFree (name);
9870 }
9871
9872 if (full_name != 0)
9873 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9874 else
9875 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9876
9877 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9878 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9879
9880 if (NILP (font_names))
9881 {
9882 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9883 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9884 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9885 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9886 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9887 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9888 Qnil);
9889
9890 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9891 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9892 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9893 make_number (fontp->size)),
9894 Qnil)),
9895 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9896 if (full_name)
9897 {
9898 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9899 Qnil);
9900 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9901 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9902 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9903 make_number (fontp->size)),
9904 Qnil)),
9905 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9906 }
9907 }
9908
9909 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9910 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9911 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9912 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9913 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9914 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9915 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9916 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9917 fontp->encoding[1]
9918 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9919 /* 1-byte font */
9920 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9921 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9922 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9923 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9924 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9925 /* 2-byte font */
9926 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9927 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9928 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9929 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9930 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9931 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9932 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9933 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9934 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9935 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9936 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9937 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9938 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9939
9940 fontp->baseline_offset
9941 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9942 ? (long) value : 0);
9943 fontp->relative_compose
9944 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9945 ? (long) value : 0);
9946 fontp->default_ascent
9947 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9948 ? (long) value : 0);
9949
9950 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9951 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9952 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9953 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9954 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9955 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9956 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9957 return fontp;
9958 }
9959 }
9960
9961
9962 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9963 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9964
9965 struct font_info *
9966 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9967 struct frame *f;
9968 register char *fontname;
9969 {
9970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9971 int i;
9972
9973 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9974 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9975 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9976 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9977 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9978 return NULL;
9979 }
9980
9981
9982 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9983 `encoder' of the structure. */
9984
9985 void
9986 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9987 struct font_info *fontp;
9988 {
9989 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9990
9991 elt = Qnil;
9992 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9993 {
9994 elt = XCAR (list);
9995 if (CONSP (elt)
9996 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9997 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9998 >= 0)
9999 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10000 >= 0)))
10001 break;
10002 }
10003
10004 if (! NILP (list))
10005 {
10006 struct ccl_program *ccl
10007 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10008
10009 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10010 xfree (ccl);
10011 else
10012 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10013 }
10014 }
10015
10016
10017 \f
10018 /***********************************************************************
10019 Initialization
10020 ***********************************************************************/
10021
10022 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10023 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10024 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10025 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10026
10027 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10028 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10029 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10030
10031 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10032 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10033 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10034 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10035 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10036 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10037 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10038 };
10039 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10040
10041 static int x_initialized;
10042
10043 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10044 static int x_session_initialized;
10045 #endif
10046
10047 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10048 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10049 the screen number from the server number. */
10050 static int
10051 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10052 const char *name1, *name2;
10053 {
10054 int seen_colon = 0;
10055 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10056 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10057 int length_until_period = 0;
10058
10059 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10060 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10061 length_until_period++;
10062
10063 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10064 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10065 name1 += 4;
10066 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10067 name2 += 4;
10068 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10069 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10070 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10071 name1 += system_name_length;
10072 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10073 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10074 name2 += system_name_length;
10075 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10076 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10077 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10078 name1 += length_until_period;
10079 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10080 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10081 name2 += length_until_period;
10082
10083 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10084 {
10085 if (*name1 == ':')
10086 seen_colon++;
10087 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10088 return 1;
10089 }
10090 return (seen_colon
10091 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10092 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10093 }
10094 #endif
10095
10096 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10097 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10098 to 5. */
10099 static void
10100 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10101 unsigned long mask;
10102 int *bits;
10103 int *offset;
10104 {
10105 int nr = 0;
10106 int off = 0;
10107
10108 while (!(mask & 1))
10109 {
10110 off++;
10111 mask >>= 1;
10112 }
10113
10114 while (mask & 1)
10115 {
10116 nr++;
10117 mask >>= 1;
10118 }
10119
10120 *offset = off;
10121 *bits = nr;
10122 }
10123
10124 int
10125 x_display_ok (display)
10126 const char * display;
10127 {
10128 int dpy_ok = 1;
10129 Display *dpy;
10130
10131 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10132 if (dpy)
10133 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10134 else
10135 dpy_ok = 0;
10136 return dpy_ok;
10137 }
10138
10139 struct x_display_info *
10140 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10141 Lisp_Object display_name;
10142 char *xrm_option;
10143 char *resource_name;
10144 {
10145 int connection;
10146 Display *dpy;
10147 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10148 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10149
10150 BLOCK_INPUT;
10151
10152 if (!x_initialized)
10153 {
10154 x_initialize ();
10155 ++x_initialized;
10156 }
10157
10158 #ifdef USE_GTK
10159 {
10160 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10161 int argc;
10162 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10163 char **argv2 = argv;
10164 GdkAtom atom;
10165
10166 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10167 {
10168 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10169 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10170 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10171 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10172 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10173 }
10174 else
10175 {
10176 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10177 argv[argc] = 0;
10178
10179 argc = 0;
10180 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10181
10182 if (! NILP (display_name))
10183 {
10184 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10185 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10186 }
10187
10188 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10189 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10190
10191 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10192 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10193 #endif
10194
10195 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10196
10197 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10198 fixup_locale ();
10199 xg_initialize ();
10200
10201 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10202
10203 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10204 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10205
10206 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10207 {
10208 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10209 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10210
10211 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10212 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10213
10214 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10215 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10216 }
10217
10218 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10219 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10220 }
10221 }
10222 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10223 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10224 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10225 errors with X11R5:
10226 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10227 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10228 So let's not use it until R6. */
10229 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10230 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10231 #endif
10232
10233 {
10234 int argc = 0;
10235 char *argv[3];
10236
10237 argv[0] = "";
10238 argc = 1;
10239 if (xrm_option)
10240 {
10241 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10242 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10243 }
10244 turn_on_atimers (0);
10245 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10246 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10247 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10248 &argc, argv);
10249 turn_on_atimers (1);
10250
10251 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10252 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10253 fixup_locale ();
10254 #endif
10255 }
10256
10257 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10258 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10259 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10260 #endif
10261 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10262 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10263 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10264
10265 /* Detect failure. */
10266 if (dpy == 0)
10267 {
10268 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10269 return 0;
10270 }
10271
10272 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10273
10274 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10275 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10276
10277 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10278 {
10279 struct x_display_info *share;
10280 Lisp_Object tail;
10281
10282 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10283 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10284 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10285 SDATA (display_name)))
10286 break;
10287 if (share)
10288 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10289 else
10290 {
10291 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10292 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10293 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10294 {
10295 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10296 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10297 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10298 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10299 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10300 BLOCK_INPUT;
10301 }
10302
10303 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10304 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10305 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10306 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10307 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10308 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10309 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10310 }
10311 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10312 }
10313 #endif
10314
10315 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10316 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10317 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10318
10319 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10320 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10321 x_display_name_list);
10322 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10323
10324 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10325
10326 #if 0
10327 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10328 #endif /* ! 0 */
10329
10330 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10331 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10332 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10333 + 2);
10334 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10335 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10336
10337 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10338 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10339
10340 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10341 #ifdef USE_GTK
10342 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10343 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10344 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10345
10346 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10347 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10348
10349 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10350 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10351 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10352 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10353 #else
10354 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10355 #endif
10356 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10357 all versions. */
10358 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10359
10360 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10361 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10362 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10363 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10364 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10365 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10366 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10367 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10368 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10369 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10370 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10371 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10372 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10373 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10374 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10375 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10376 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10377 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10378 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10379 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10380 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10381 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10383 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10384 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10385 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10386 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10387 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10388 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10389 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10390 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10391 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10392 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10393
10394 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10395 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10396 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10397
10398 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10399 {
10400 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10401 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10402 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10403 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10404 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10405 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10406 }
10407
10408 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10409 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10410 {
10411 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10412 {
10413 Lisp_Object value;
10414 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10415 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10416 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10417 Qnil, Qnil);
10418 if (STRINGP (value)
10419 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10420 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10421 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10422 }
10423 }
10424 else
10425 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10426 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10427
10428 {
10429 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10430 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10431 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10432 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10433 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10434 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10435 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10436 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10437 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10438 }
10439
10440 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10441 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10442 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10443 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10444 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10445 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10446 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10447 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10448 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10449 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10450 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10451 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10452 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10453 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10454 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10455 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10456 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10457 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10458 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10459 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10460 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10461 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10462 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10463 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10464 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10465 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10466 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10467 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10468 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10469 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10470 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10471 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10472 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10473 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10474 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10475 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10476 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10477 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10478 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10479 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10480 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10481 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10482 /* For properties of font. */
10483 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10484 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10485 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10486 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10487 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10488 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10489 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10490 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10491 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10492 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10493
10494 /* Ghostscript support. */
10495 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10496 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10497
10498 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10499 False);
10500
10501 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10502
10503 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10504 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10505
10506 {
10507 char null_bits[1];
10508
10509 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10510
10511 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10512 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10513 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10514 1);
10515 }
10516
10517 {
10518 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10519 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10520 dpyinfo->gray
10521 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10522 gray_bitmap_bits,
10523 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10524 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10525 }
10526
10527 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10528 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10529 #endif
10530
10531 #ifdef subprocesses
10532 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10533 if (connection != 0)
10534 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10535 #endif
10536
10537 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10538 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10539 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10540 /* stdin is a socket here */
10541 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10542 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10543 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10544 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10545 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10546 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10547
10548 #ifdef SIGIO
10549 if (interrupt_input)
10550 init_sigio (connection);
10551 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10552
10553 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10554 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10555 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10556 so that Xt does not crash. */
10557 {
10558 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10559 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10560 Font font;
10561
10562 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10563 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10564 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10565 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10566 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10567 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10568 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10569 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10570 abort ();
10571 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10572 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10573 x_uncatch_errors ();
10574 }
10575 #endif
10576 #endif
10577
10578 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10579 for debugging X code. */
10580 {
10581 Lisp_Object value;
10582 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10583 build_string ("synchronous"),
10584 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10585 Qnil, Qnil);
10586 if (STRINGP (value)
10587 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10588 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10589 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10590 }
10591
10592 {
10593 Lisp_Object value;
10594 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10595 build_string ("useXIM"),
10596 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10597 Qnil, Qnil);
10598 #ifdef USE_XIM
10599 if (STRINGP (value)
10600 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10601 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10602 use_xim = 0;
10603 #else
10604 if (STRINGP (value)
10605 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10606 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10607 use_xim = 1;
10608 #endif
10609 }
10610
10611 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10612 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10613 if (!x_session_initialized++)
10614 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10615 #endif
10616
10617 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10618
10619 return dpyinfo;
10620 }
10621 \f
10622 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10623 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10624
10625 void
10626 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10628 {
10629 int i;
10630
10631 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10632
10633 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10634 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10635 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10636 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10637 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10638 else
10639 {
10640 Lisp_Object tail;
10641
10642 tail = x_display_name_list;
10643 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10644 {
10645 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10646 {
10647 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10648 break;
10649 }
10650 tail = XCDR (tail);
10651 }
10652 }
10653
10654 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10655 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10656
10657 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10658 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10659 else
10660 {
10661 struct x_display_info *tail;
10662
10663 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10664 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10665 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10666 }
10667
10668 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10669 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10670 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10671 #endif
10672 #endif
10673 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10674 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10675 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10676 #endif
10677 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10678 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10679 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10680 #endif
10681
10682 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10683 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10684 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10685 {
10686 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10687 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10688 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10689 }
10690
10691 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10692 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10693
10694 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10695 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10696 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10697 xfree (dpyinfo);
10698 }
10699
10700 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10701
10702 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10703 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10704 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10705 that slows us down. */
10706
10707 static void
10708 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10709 struct atimer *timer;
10710 {
10711 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10712 {
10713 BLOCK_INPUT;
10714 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10715 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10716 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10717 }
10718 }
10719
10720 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10721
10722 \f
10723 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10724
10725 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10726
10727 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10728 {
10729 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10730 x_produce_glyphs,
10731 x_write_glyphs,
10732 x_insert_glyphs,
10733 x_clear_end_of_line,
10734 x_scroll_run,
10735 x_after_update_window_line,
10736 x_update_window_begin,
10737 x_update_window_end,
10738 x_cursor_to,
10739 x_flush,
10740 #ifdef XFlush
10741 x_flush,
10742 #else
10743 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10744 #endif
10745 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10746 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10747 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10748 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10749 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10750 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10751 x_per_char_metric,
10752 x_encode_char,
10753 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10754 x_draw_glyph_string,
10755 x_define_frame_cursor,
10756 x_clear_frame_area,
10757 x_draw_window_cursor,
10758 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10760 };
10761
10762 void
10763 x_initialize ()
10764 {
10765 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10766
10767 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10768 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10769 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10770 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10771 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10772 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10773 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10774 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10775 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10776 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10777 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10778 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10779 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10780 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10781 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10782 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10783 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10784 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10785
10786 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10787 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10788 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10789 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10790 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10791 off the bottom */
10792 baud_rate = 19200;
10793
10794 x_noop_count = 0;
10795 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10796 any_help_event_p = 0;
10797 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10798 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10799 x_session_initialized = 0;
10800 #endif
10801
10802 #ifdef USE_GTK
10803 current_count = -1;
10804 #endif
10805
10806 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10807 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10808
10809 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10810 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10811
10812 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10813
10814 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10815 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10816 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10817 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10818 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10819 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10820 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10821
10822 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10823
10824 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10825 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10826 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10827 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10828 widgets don't behave normally. */
10829 {
10830 EMACS_TIME interval;
10831 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10832 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10833 }
10834 #endif
10835
10836 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10837 #ifndef USE_GTK
10838 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10839 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10840 #endif
10841 #endif
10842
10843 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10844 original error handler. */
10845 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10846 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10847
10848 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10849 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10850 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10851 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10852
10853 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10854 }
10855
10856
10857 void
10858 syms_of_xterm ()
10859 {
10860 x_error_message = NULL;
10861
10862 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10863 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10864
10865 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10866 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10867
10868 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10869 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10870
10871 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10872 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10873 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10874 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10875
10876 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10877 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10878
10879 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10880 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10881 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10882 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10883 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10884 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10885 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10886
10887 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10888 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10889 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10890 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10891 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10892 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10893 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10894 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10895 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10896
10897 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10898 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10899 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10900 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10901 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10902 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10903 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10904 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10905 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10906 #elif USE_GTK
10907 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10908 #else
10909 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10910 #endif
10911 #else
10912 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10913 #endif
10914
10915 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10916 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10917
10918 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10919 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10920 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10921 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10922 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10923 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10924 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10925 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10926 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10927
10928 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10929 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10930 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10931 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10932 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10933 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10934
10935 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10936 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10937 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10938 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10939 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10940 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10941
10942 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10943 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10944 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10945 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10946 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10947 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10948
10949 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10950 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10951 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10952 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10953 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10954 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10955
10956 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10957 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10958 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10959 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10960 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10961 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10962 }
10963
10964 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10965
10966 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10967 (do not change this comment) */